Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in bfd
elf32-ppc.c revision 1.9
      1  1.1  christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
      2  1.9  christos    Copyright (C) 1994-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
      3  1.1  christos    Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
      4  1.1  christos 
      5  1.1  christos    This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
      6  1.1  christos 
      7  1.1  christos    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
      8  1.1  christos    it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
      9  1.1  christos    the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
     10  1.1  christos    (at your option) any later version.
     11  1.1  christos 
     12  1.1  christos    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
     13  1.1  christos    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
     14  1.1  christos    MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
     15  1.1  christos    GNU General Public License for more details.
     16  1.1  christos 
     17  1.1  christos    You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
     18  1.1  christos    along with this program; if not, write to the
     19  1.1  christos    Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
     20  1.1  christos    Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.  */
     21  1.1  christos 
     22  1.1  christos 
     23  1.1  christos /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI.  The
     24  1.1  christos    information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI.  It includes
     25  1.1  christos    suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
     26  1.1  christos    information may also not match.  */
     27  1.1  christos 
     28  1.1  christos #include "sysdep.h"
     29  1.1  christos #include <stdarg.h>
     30  1.1  christos #include "bfd.h"
     31  1.1  christos #include "bfdlink.h"
     32  1.1  christos #include "libbfd.h"
     33  1.1  christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
     34  1.1  christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
     35  1.1  christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
     36  1.1  christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
     37  1.1  christos #include "dwarf2.h"
     38  1.7  christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
     39  1.1  christos 
     40  1.9  christos /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1.  */
     41  1.9  christos #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
     42  1.9  christos 
     43  1.1  christos typedef enum split16_format_type
     44  1.1  christos {
     45  1.1  christos   split16a_type = 0,
     46  1.1  christos   split16d_type
     47  1.1  christos }
     48  1.1  christos split16_format_type;
     49  1.1  christos 
     50  1.1  christos /* RELA relocations are used here.  */
     51  1.1  christos 
     52  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
     53  1.1  christos   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     54  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
     55  1.1  christos   (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
     56  1.1  christos 
     57  1.1  christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs.  */
     58  1.1  christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
     59  1.1  christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions.  */
     60  1.1  christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
     61  1.1  christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA.  */
     62  1.1  christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
     63  1.1  christos 
     64  1.1  christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter.  This is put in the .interp
     65  1.1  christos    section.  */
     66  1.1  christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
     67  1.1  christos 
     68  1.1  christos /* For old-style PLT.  */
     69  1.1  christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots).  */
     70  1.1  christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
     71  1.1  christos 
     72  1.1  christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt.  */
     73  1.1  christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
     74  1.8  christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h)					\
     75  1.8  christos   ((4*4									\
     76  1.8  christos     + (h != NULL							\
     77  1.8  christos        && h == htab->tls_get_addr					\
     78  1.8  christos        && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0)			\
     79  1.8  christos     + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1)				\
     80  1.8  christos    & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
     81  1.1  christos 
     82  1.1  christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker.  */
     83  1.1  christos 
     84  1.1  christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry.  */
     85  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
     86  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
     87  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
     88  1.1  christos   {
     89  1.8  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0		 */
     90  1.8  christos     0x818c0000, /* lwz	   r12,0(r12)		 */
     91  1.8  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr   r12			 */
     92  1.8  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr				 */
     93  1.8  christos     0x39600000, /* li	   r11,0		 */
     94  1.8  christos     0x48000000, /* b	   14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
     95  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     96  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop				 */
     97  1.1  christos   };
     98  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
     99  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    100  1.1  christos   {
    101  1.1  christos     0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
    102  1.1  christos     0x818c0000, /* lwz	 r12,0(r12) */
    103  1.1  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
    104  1.1  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
    105  1.1  christos     0x39600000, /* li	 r11,0 */
    106  1.1  christos     0x48000000, /* b	 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
    107  1.1  christos     0x60000000, /* nop */
    108  1.1  christos     0x60000000, /* nop */
    109  1.1  christos   };
    110  1.1  christos 
    111  1.1  christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry.  */
    112  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
    113  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
    114  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    115  1.1  christos   {
    116  1.8  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis	   r12,0	*/
    117  1.8  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi	   r12,r12,0	*/
    118  1.8  christos     0x800c0008, /* lwz	   r0,8(r12)	*/
    119  1.8  christos     0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr   r0		*/
    120  1.8  christos     0x818c0004, /* lwz	   r12,4(r12)	*/
    121  1.8  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr			*/
    122  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    123  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop			*/
    124  1.1  christos   };
    125  1.1  christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
    126  1.1  christos     [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
    127  1.1  christos   {
    128  1.1  christos     0x819e0008, /* lwz	 r12,8(r30) */
    129  1.8  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12	    */
    130  1.1  christos     0x819e0004, /* lwz	 r12,4(r30) */
    131  1.8  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr		    */
    132  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    133  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    134  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    135  1.8  christos     0x60000000, /* nop		    */
    136  1.1  christos   };
    137  1.1  christos 
    138  1.1  christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
    139  1.1  christos    .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader.  */
    140  1.1  christos 
    141  1.1  christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
    142  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
    143  1.1  christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
    144  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
    145  1.8  christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
    146  1.1  christos    a shared library. */
    147  1.1  christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
    148  1.1  christos 
    149  1.1  christos /* Some instructions.  */
    150  1.1  christos #define ADDIS_11_11	0x3d6b0000
    151  1.1  christos #define ADDIS_11_30	0x3d7e0000
    152  1.1  christos #define ADDIS_12_12	0x3d8c0000
    153  1.1  christos #define ADDI_11_11	0x396b0000
    154  1.1  christos #define ADD_0_11_11	0x7c0b5a14
    155  1.1  christos #define ADD_3_12_2	0x7c6c1214
    156  1.1  christos #define ADD_11_0_11	0x7d605a14
    157  1.1  christos #define B		0x48000000
    158  1.3  christos #define BA		0x48000002
    159  1.1  christos #define BCL_20_31	0x429f0005
    160  1.1  christos #define BCTR		0x4e800420
    161  1.1  christos #define BEQLR		0x4d820020
    162  1.1  christos #define CMPWI_11_0	0x2c0b0000
    163  1.1  christos #define LIS_11		0x3d600000
    164  1.1  christos #define LIS_12		0x3d800000
    165  1.1  christos #define LWZU_0_12	0x840c0000
    166  1.1  christos #define LWZ_0_12	0x800c0000
    167  1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_3	0x81630000
    168  1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_11	0x816b0000
    169  1.1  christos #define LWZ_11_30	0x817e0000
    170  1.1  christos #define LWZ_12_3	0x81830000
    171  1.1  christos #define LWZ_12_12	0x818c0000
    172  1.1  christos #define MR_0_3		0x7c601b78
    173  1.1  christos #define MR_3_0		0x7c030378
    174  1.1  christos #define MFLR_0		0x7c0802a6
    175  1.1  christos #define MFLR_12		0x7d8802a6
    176  1.1  christos #define MTCTR_0		0x7c0903a6
    177  1.1  christos #define MTCTR_11	0x7d6903a6
    178  1.1  christos #define MTLR_0		0x7c0803a6
    179  1.1  christos #define NOP		0x60000000
    180  1.1  christos #define SUB_11_11_12	0x7d6c5850
    181  1.1  christos 
    182  1.1  christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block.  */
    183  1.1  christos #define TP_OFFSET	0x7000
    184  1.1  christos #define DTP_OFFSET	0x8000
    185  1.1  christos 
    186  1.1  christos /* The value of a defined global symbol.  */
    187  1.1  christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
    188  1.1  christos   ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma	\
    189  1.1  christos    + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset		\
    190  1.1  christos    + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
    191  1.1  christos 
    192  1.8  christos /* Relocation HOWTO's.  */
    194  1.8  christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
    195  1.8  christos    field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
    196  1.8  christos    always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
    197  1.8  christos    PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
    198  1.8  christos    the LSB.  For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
    199  1.8  christos    and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
    200  1.8  christos    rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0.  */
    201  1.8  christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
    202  1.8  christos 	    complain, special_func)				\
    203  1.8  christos   HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0,	\
    204  1.8  christos 	 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func,		\
    205  1.8  christos 	 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
    206  1.1  christos 
    207  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
    208  1.1  christos 
    209  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
    210  1.8  christos   /* This reloc does nothing.  */
    211  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    212  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    213  1.1  christos 
    214  1.8  christos   /* A standard 32 bit relocation.  */
    215  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    216  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    217  1.1  christos 
    218  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    219  1.8  christos      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    220  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    221  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    222  1.1  christos 
    223  1.8  christos   /* A standard 16 bit relocation.  */
    224  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
    225  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    226  1.1  christos 
    227  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow.  */
    228  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    229  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    230  1.1  christos 
    231  1.8  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of an address.  */
    232  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    233  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    234  1.1  christos 
    235  1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
    236  1.8  christos      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    237  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    238  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    239  1.1  christos 
    240  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
    241  1.8  christos      FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them.  */
    242  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    243  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    244  1.1  christos 
    245  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    246  1.1  christos      indicate that the branch is expected to be taken.	The lower two
    247  1.8  christos      bits must be zero.  */
    248  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    249  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    250  1.1  christos 
    251  1.1  christos   /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
    252  1.1  christos      indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower
    253  1.8  christos      two bits must be zero.  */
    254  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
    255  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    256  1.1  christos 
    257  1.8  christos   /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    258  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    259  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    260  1.1  christos 
    261  1.8  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.  */
    262  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    263  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    264  1.1  christos 
    265  1.1  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    266  1.1  christos      the branch is expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must be
    267  1.8  christos      zero.  */
    268  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    269  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    270  1.1  christos 
    271  1.1  christos   /* A relative 16 bit branch.  Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
    272  1.1  christos      the branch is not expected to be taken.  The lower two bits must
    273  1.8  christos      be zero.  */
    274  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    275  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    276  1.1  christos 
    277  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
    278  1.8  christos      symbol.  */
    279  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    280  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    281  1.1  christos 
    282  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    283  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    284  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    285  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    286  1.1  christos 
    287  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    288  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    289  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    290  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    291  1.1  christos 
    292  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
    293  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    294  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    295  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    296  1.1  christos 
    297  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
    298  1.8  christos      entry for the symbol.  */
    299  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    300  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    301  1.1  christos 
    302  1.1  christos   /* This is used only by the dynamic linker.  The symbol should exist
    303  1.1  christos      both in the object being run and in some shared library.  The
    304  1.1  christos      dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
    305  1.1  christos      shared library into the object, because the object being
    306  1.8  christos      run has to have the data at some particular address.  */
    307  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    308  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    309  1.1  christos 
    310  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
    311  1.8  christos      entries.  */
    312  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    313  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    314  1.1  christos 
    315  1.8  christos   /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol.  */
    316  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    317  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    318  1.1  christos 
    319  1.1  christos   /* Used only by the dynamic linker.  When the object is run, this
    320  1.1  christos      longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
    321  1.8  christos      addend.  */
    322  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    323  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    324  1.1  christos 
    325  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
    326  1.1  christos      object rather than the final value.  Normally used for
    327  1.8  christos      _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
    328  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
    329  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    330  1.1  christos 
    331  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned.  */
    332  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    333  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    334  1.1  christos 
    335  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned.  */
    336  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
    337  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    338  1.1  christos 
    339  1.8  christos   /* 32-bit PC relative */
    340  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
    341  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    342  1.1  christos 
    343  1.1  christos   /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    344  1.8  christos      FIXME: not supported.  */
    345  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    346  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    347  1.1  christos 
    348  1.1  christos   /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
    349  1.8  christos      FIXME: not supported.  */
    350  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
    351  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    352  1.1  christos 
    353  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    354  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    355  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    356  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    357  1.1  christos 
    358  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    359  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    360  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    361  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    362  1.1  christos 
    363  1.1  christos   /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
    364  1.8  christos      the symbol.  */
    365  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    366  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    367  1.1  christos 
    368  1.1  christos   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
    369  1.8  christos      small data items.  */
    370  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    371  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    372  1.1  christos 
    373  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit section relative relocation.  */
    374  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    375  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    376  1.1  christos 
    377  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation.  */
    378  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    379  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    380  1.1  christos 
    381  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation.  */
    382  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    383  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    384  1.1  christos 
    385  1.8  christos   /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation.  */
    386  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    387  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    388  1.1  christos 
    389  1.8  christos   /* Marker relocs for TLS.  */
    390  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    391  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    392  1.8  christos 
    393  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    394  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    395  1.8  christos 
    396  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    397  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    398  1.8  christos 
    399  1.8  christos   /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions.  */
    400  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    401  1.8  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    402  1.8  christos 
    403  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    404  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    405  1.1  christos 
    406  1.1  christos   /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
    407  1.8  christos      definition of its TLS sym.  */
    408  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    409  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    410  1.1  christos 
    411  1.1  christos   /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
    412  1.1  christos      of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
    413  1.8  christos      contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000.  */
    414  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    415  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    416  1.1  christos 
    417  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc.  */
    418  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    419  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    420  1.1  christos 
    421  1.8  christos   /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    422  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    423  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    424  1.1  christos 
    425  1.8  christos   /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    426  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    427  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    428  1.1  christos 
    429  1.8  christos   /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    430  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    431  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    432  1.1  christos 
    433  1.1  christos   /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
    434  1.8  christos      sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13).  */
    435  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    436  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    437  1.1  christos 
    438  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit tprel reloc.  */
    439  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    440  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    441  1.1  christos 
    442  1.8  christos   /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    443  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    444  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    445  1.1  christos 
    446  1.8  christos   /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    447  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    448  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    449  1.1  christos 
    450  1.8  christos   /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    451  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    452  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    453  1.1  christos 
    454  1.1  christos   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    455  1.1  christos      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
    456  1.8  christos      to the first entry.  */
    457  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    458  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    459  1.1  christos 
    460  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow.  */
    461  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    462  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    463  1.1  christos 
    464  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    465  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    466  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    467  1.1  christos 
    468  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    469  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    470  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    471  1.1  christos 
    472  1.1  christos   /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
    473  1.1  christos      with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
    474  1.8  christos      first entry.  */
    475  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    476  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    477  1.1  christos 
    478  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow.  */
    479  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    480  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    481  1.1  christos 
    482  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    483  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    484  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    485  1.1  christos 
    486  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    487  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    488  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    489  1.1  christos 
    490  1.1  christos   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
    491  1.8  christos      the offset to the entry.  */
    492  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    493  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    494  1.1  christos 
    495  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    496  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    497  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    498  1.1  christos 
    499  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    500  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    501  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    502  1.1  christos 
    503  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    504  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    505  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    506  1.1  christos 
    507  1.1  christos   /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
    508  1.8  christos      offset to the entry.  */
    509  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    510  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    511  1.1  christos 
    512  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow.  */
    513  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    514  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    515  1.1  christos 
    516  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits.  */
    517  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    518  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    519  1.1  christos 
    520  1.8  christos   /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits.  */
    521  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    522  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    523  1.1  christos 
    524  1.1  christos   /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
    525  1.1  christos      in the SVR4 ELF ABI.  */
    526  1.1  christos 
    527  1.8  christos   /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    528  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    529  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    530  1.1  christos 
    531  1.8  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    532  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    533  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    534  1.1  christos 
    535  1.8  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol.  */
    536  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    537  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    538  1.1  christos 
    539  1.8  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol.  */
    540  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    541  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    542  1.1  christos 
    543  1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
    544  1.1  christos      plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
    545  1.8  christos      is negative.  */
    546  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    547  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    548  1.1  christos 
    549  1.1  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    550  1.1  christos      address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
    551  1.8  christos      _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    552  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    553  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    554  1.1  christos 
    555  1.1  christos   /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
    556  1.1  christos      address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
    557  1.8  christos      _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation.  */
    558  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    559  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    560  1.1  christos 
    561  1.1  christos   /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
    562  1.8  christos      small data items.	 */
    563  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    564  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    565  1.1  christos 
    566  1.1  christos   /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
    567  1.1  christos      signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
    568  1.8  christos      field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    569  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    570  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    571  1.1  christos 
    572  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
    573  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
    574  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
    575  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
    576  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
    577  1.1  christos   /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
    578  1.1  christos 
    579  1.1  christos   /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
    580  1.1  christos      in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
    581  1.8  christos      register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13).  */
    582  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    583  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    584  1.1  christos 
    585  1.8  christos   /* A relative 8 bit branch.  */
    586  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
    587  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    588  1.1  christos 
    589  1.8  christos   /* A relative 15 bit branch.  */
    590  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
    591  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    592  1.1  christos 
    593  1.8  christos   /* A relative 24 bit branch.  */
    594  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
    595  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    596  1.1  christos 
    597  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format.  */
    598  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    599  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    600  1.1  christos 
    601  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format.  */
    602  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    603  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    604  1.1  christos 
    605  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 split16a format.  */
    606  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    607  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    608  1.1  christos 
    609  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 split16d format.  */
    610  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    611  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    612  1.1  christos 
    613  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format.  */
    614  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    615  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    616  1.1  christos 
    617  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format.  */
    618  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    619  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    620  1.3  christos 
    621  1.3  christos   /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
    622  1.3  christos      instructions.  If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
    623  1.8  christos      the e_add16i to an e_li instruction.  */
    624  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    625  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    626  1.3  christos 
    627  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow.  */
    628  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    629  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    630  1.1  christos 
    631  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    632  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    633  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    634  1.1  christos 
    635  1.8  christos   /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    636  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    637  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    638  1.1  christos 
    639  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format.  */
    640  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    641  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    642  1.1  christos 
    643  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format.  */
    644  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    645  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    646  1.1  christos 
    647  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format.  */
    648  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    649  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    650  1.1  christos 
    651  1.8  christos   /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format.  */
    652  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
    653  1.8  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    654  1.8  christos 
    655  1.8  christos   /* e_li split20 format.  */
    656  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    657  1.8  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    658  1.8  christos 
    659  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
    660  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    661  1.1  christos 
    662  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit relative relocation.  */
    663  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
    664  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    665  1.1  christos 
    666  1.8  christos   /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow.  */
    667  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
    668  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    669  1.1  christos 
    670  1.8  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address.  */
    671  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
    672  1.1  christos        bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
    673  1.1  christos 
    674  1.1  christos   /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
    675  1.8  christos      the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative.  */
    676  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
    677  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    678  1.6  christos 
    679  1.8  christos   /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis.  */
    680  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
    681  1.6  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    682  1.7  christos 
    683  1.8  christos   /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only).  */
    684  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
    685  1.7  christos        ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
    686  1.1  christos 
    687  1.8  christos   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy.  */
    688  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    689  1.1  christos        NULL),
    690  1.1  christos 
    691  1.8  christos   /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage.  */
    692  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
    693  1.1  christos        NULL),
    694  1.1  christos 
    695  1.8  christos   /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries.  */
    696  1.8  christos   HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
    697  1.1  christos        ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
    698  1.1  christos };
    699  1.1  christos 
    700  1.1  christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done.  */
    702  1.1  christos 
    703  1.1  christos static void
    704  1.1  christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
    705  1.1  christos {
    706  1.1  christos   unsigned int i, type;
    707  1.1  christos 
    708  1.1  christos   for (i = 0;
    709  1.1  christos        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    710  1.1  christos        i++)
    711  1.1  christos     {
    712  1.1  christos       type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
    713  1.1  christos       if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
    714  1.1  christos 		   / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
    715  1.1  christos 	abort ();
    716  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    717  1.1  christos     }
    718  1.1  christos }
    719  1.1  christos 
    720  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *
    721  1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    722  1.1  christos 			   bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
    723  1.1  christos {
    724  1.1  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
    725  1.1  christos 
    726  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    727  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    728  1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    729  1.1  christos 
    730  1.1  christos   switch (code)
    731  1.1  christos     {
    732  1.1  christos     default:
    733  1.1  christos       return NULL;
    734  1.1  christos 
    735  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_NONE:		r = R_PPC_NONE;			break;
    736  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32:			r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    737  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26:		r = R_PPC_ADDR24;		break;
    738  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
    739  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16:			r = R_PPC_ADDR16;		break;
    740  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
    741  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO;		break;
    742  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI;		break;
    743  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S:		r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA;		break;
    744  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16:		r = R_PPC_ADDR14;		break;
    745  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    746  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    747  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26:		r = R_PPC_REL24;		break;
    748  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16:		r = R_PPC_REL14;		break;
    749  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN;	break;
    750  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN:	r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN;	break;
    751  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
    752  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16;		break;
    753  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
    754  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;		break;
    755  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF:		r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI;		break;
    756  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF:	r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA;		break;
    757  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL24;		break;
    758  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY:		r = R_PPC_COPY;			break;
    759  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT:	r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT;		break;
    760  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC:	r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC;		break;
    761  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL32;		break;
    762  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT32;		break;
    763  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_PLTREL32;		break;
    764  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
    765  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO;		break;
    766  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF:		r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI;		break;
    767  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF:	r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA;		break;
    768  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16:		r = R_PPC_SDAREL16;		break;
    769  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
    770  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL:		r = R_PPC_SECTOFF;		break;
    771  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
    772  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO;		break;
    773  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI;		break;
    774  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL:	r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA;		break;
    775  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_CTOR:		r = R_PPC_ADDR32;		break;
    776  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
    777  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16:		r = R_PPC_TOC16;		break;
    778  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS:		r = R_PPC_TLS;			break;
    779  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD:		r = R_PPC_TLSGD;		break;
    780  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD:		r = R_PPC_TLSLD;		break;
    781  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD:		r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32;		break;
    782  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
    783  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16:		r = R_PPC_TPREL16;		break;
    784  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
    785  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;		break;
    786  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI;		break;
    787  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;		break;
    788  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL:		r = R_PPC_TPREL32;		break;
    789  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
    790  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16;		break;
    791  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
    792  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO;		break;
    793  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI;		break;
    794  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA;		break;
    795  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL:		r = R_PPC_DTPREL32;		break;
    796  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16;		break;
    797  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO;	break;
    798  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI;	break;
    799  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA;	break;
    800  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16;		break;
    801  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO;	break;
    802  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI;	break;
    803  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA;	break;
    804  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16;		break;
    805  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO;	break;
    806  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI;	break;
    807  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA;	break;
    808  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16;		break;
    809  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO;	break;
    810  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI;	break;
    811  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:	r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA;	break;
    812  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32;		break;
    813  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16;		break;
    814  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO;	break;
    815  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI;	break;
    816  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA;	break;
    817  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16;		break;
    818  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16;		break;
    819  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL;		break;
    820  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21;		break;
    821  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:	r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF;		break;
    822  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16;		break;
    823  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO;		break;
    824  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI;		break;
    825  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA;		break;
    826  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:	r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD;		break;
    827  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:	r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA;		break;
    828  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8;		break;
    829  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15;		break;
    830  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24:	r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24;		break;
    831  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A;		break;
    832  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D;		break;
    833  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A;		break;
    834  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D;		break;
    835  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A;		break;
    836  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D:	r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D;		break;
    837  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21;		break;
    838  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:	r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO;		break;
    839  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
    840  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
    841  1.1  christos       break;
    842  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
    843  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
    844  1.1  christos       break;
    845  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
    846  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
    847  1.1  christos       break;
    848  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
    849  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
    850  1.1  christos       break;
    851  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
    852  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
    853  1.1  christos       break;
    854  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
    855  1.1  christos       r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
    856  1.1  christos       break;
    857  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16;		break;
    858  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_LO;		break;
    859  1.7  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL:		r = R_PPC_REL16_HI;		break;
    860  1.6  christos     case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL:	r = R_PPC_REL16_HA;		break;
    861  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA:		r = R_PPC_16DX_HA;		break;
    862  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA:	r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA;		break;
    863  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT;	break;
    864  1.1  christos     case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY:	r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY;		break;
    865  1.1  christos     }
    866  1.1  christos 
    867  1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
    868  1.1  christos };
    869  1.1  christos 
    870  1.1  christos static reloc_howto_type *
    871  1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
    872  1.1  christos 			   const char *r_name)
    873  1.1  christos {
    874  1.1  christos   unsigned int i;
    875  1.1  christos 
    876  1.1  christos   for (i = 0;
    877  1.1  christos        i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
    878  1.1  christos        i++)
    879  1.1  christos     if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
    880  1.1  christos 	&& strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
    881  1.1  christos       return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
    882  1.1  christos 
    883  1.1  christos   return NULL;
    884  1.1  christos }
    885  1.1  christos 
    886  1.8  christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc.  */
    887  1.7  christos 
    888  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
    889  1.1  christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
    890  1.1  christos 		       arelent *cache_ptr,
    891  1.5  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
    892  1.5  christos {
    893  1.1  christos   unsigned int r_type;
    894  1.1  christos 
    895  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
    896  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
    897  1.5  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
    898  1.5  christos 
    899  1.5  christos   r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
    900  1.7  christos   if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
    901  1.8  christos     {
    902  1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    903  1.5  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    904  1.8  christos 			  abfd, r_type);
    905  1.5  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    906  1.8  christos       return FALSE;
    907  1.5  christos     }
    908  1.1  christos 
    909  1.1  christos   cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
    910  1.1  christos 
    911  1.8  christos   /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
    912  1.1  christos      ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation.  */
    913  1.7  christos   if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
    914  1.8  christos     {
    915  1.7  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
    916  1.1  christos       _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
    917  1.1  christos 			  abfd, r_type);
    918  1.8  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
    919  1.1  christos 
    920  1.8  christos       return FALSE;
    921  1.8  christos     }
    922  1.1  christos 
    923  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
    924  1.1  christos }
    925  1.1  christos 
    926  1.1  christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs.  */
    927  1.7  christos 
    928  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
    929  1.1  christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    930  1.7  christos 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    931  1.1  christos 			 asymbol *symbol,
    932  1.1  christos 			 void *data,
    933  1.1  christos 			 asection *input_section,
    934  1.1  christos 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    935  1.6  christos 			 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
    936  1.6  christos {
    937  1.6  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
    938  1.6  christos   long insn;
    939  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type octets;
    940  1.1  christos   bfd_vma value;
    941  1.1  christos 
    942  1.1  christos   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    943  1.1  christos     {
    944  1.1  christos       reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
    945  1.1  christos       return bfd_reloc_ok;
    946  1.6  christos     }
    947  1.6  christos 
    948  1.6  christos   reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
    949  1.6  christos   r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
    950  1.6  christos   if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
    951  1.6  christos     return bfd_reloc_continue;
    952  1.6  christos 
    953  1.6  christos   value = 0;
    954  1.6  christos   if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
    955  1.6  christos     value = symbol->value;
    956  1.6  christos   value += (reloc_entry->addend
    957  1.6  christos 	    + symbol->section->output_offset
    958  1.6  christos 	    + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
    959  1.6  christos   value -= (reloc_entry->address
    960  1.6  christos 	    + input_section->output_offset
    961  1.6  christos 	    + input_section->output_section->vma);
    962  1.9  christos   value >>= 16;
    963  1.6  christos 
    964  1.6  christos   octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
    965  1.6  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    966  1.6  christos   insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
    967  1.6  christos   insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
    968  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
    969  1.1  christos   return bfd_reloc_ok;
    970  1.1  christos }
    971  1.1  christos 
    972  1.1  christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
    973  1.1  christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
    974  1.1  christos 			 arelent *reloc_entry,
    975  1.1  christos 			 asymbol *symbol,
    976  1.1  christos 			 void *data,
    977  1.1  christos 			 asection *input_section,
    978  1.1  christos 			 bfd *output_bfd,
    979  1.1  christos 			 char **error_message)
    980  1.1  christos {
    981  1.1  christos   /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
    982  1.1  christos      call the generic function.  Any adjustment will be done at final
    983  1.1  christos      link time.  */
    984  1.1  christos   if (output_bfd != NULL)
    985  1.1  christos     return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
    986  1.1  christos 				  input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
    987  1.1  christos 
    988  1.1  christos   if (error_message != NULL)
    989  1.1  christos     {
    990  1.1  christos       static char buf[60];
    991  1.1  christos       sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
    992  1.1  christos 	       reloc_entry->howto->name);
    993  1.1  christos       *error_message = buf;
    994  1.1  christos     }
    995  1.1  christos   return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
    996  1.1  christos }
    997  1.1  christos 
    998  1.1  christos /* Sections created by the linker.  */
   1000  1.1  christos 
   1001  1.1  christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
   1002  1.1  christos {
   1003  1.1  christos   /* Pointer to the bfd section.  */
   1004  1.1  christos   asection *section;
   1005  1.1  christos   /* Section name.  */
   1006  1.1  christos   const char *name;
   1007  1.1  christos   /* Associated bss section name.  */
   1008  1.1  christos   const char *bss_name;
   1009  1.1  christos   /* Associated symbol name.  */
   1010  1.1  christos   const char *sym_name;
   1011  1.1  christos   /* Associated symbol.  */
   1012  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
   1013  1.1  christos } elf_linker_section_t;
   1014  1.1  christos 
   1015  1.1  christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries.  This hangs off of the
   1016  1.1  christos    symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
   1017  1.1  christos    based on different addend's.  */
   1018  1.1  christos 
   1019  1.1  christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
   1020  1.1  christos {
   1021  1.1  christos   /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
   1022  1.1  christos   struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
   1023  1.1  christos   /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
   1024  1.1  christos   bfd_vma offset;
   1025  1.1  christos   /* addend used */
   1026  1.1  christos   bfd_vma addend;
   1027  1.1  christos   /* which linker section this is */
   1028  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
   1029  1.1  christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
   1030  1.1  christos 
   1031  1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
   1032  1.1  christos {
   1033  1.1  christos   struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
   1034  1.1  christos 
   1035  1.1  christos   /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
   1036  1.1  christos      sections added.  This is index by the symbol index.  */
   1037  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
   1038  1.1  christos 
   1039  1.1  christos   /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type.  */
   1040  1.1  christos   unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
   1041  1.1  christos   unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
   1042  1.1  christos };
   1043  1.1  christos 
   1044  1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
   1045  1.1  christos   ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
   1046  1.1  christos 
   1047  1.1  christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
   1048  1.1  christos   (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
   1049  1.1  christos 
   1050  1.1  christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
   1051  1.1  christos   (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
   1052  1.1  christos    && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
   1053  1.1  christos 
   1054  1.1  christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras.  */
   1055  1.1  christos 
   1056  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1057  1.1  christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
   1058  1.1  christos {
   1059  1.1  christos   return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
   1060  1.6  christos 				  PPC32_ELF_DATA);
   1061  1.6  christos }
   1062  1.6  christos 
   1063  1.6  christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match.  */
   1064  1.6  christos 
   1065  1.6  christos bfd_boolean
   1066  1.6  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
   1067  1.6  christos {
   1068  1.6  christos   unsigned long mach = 0;
   1069  1.6  christos   asection *s;
   1070  1.6  christos   unsigned char *contents;
   1071  1.6  christos 
   1072  1.6  christos   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
   1073  1.6  christos       && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
   1074  1.6  christos     {
   1075  1.6  christos 
   1076  1.6  christos       for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   1077  1.6  christos 	if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1078  1.6  christos 	  break;
   1079  1.6  christos       if (s != NULL)
   1080  1.6  christos 	mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1081  1.6  christos     }
   1082  1.6  christos 
   1083  1.9  christos   if (mach == 0)
   1084  1.9  christos     {
   1085  1.9  christos       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1086  1.6  christos       if (s != NULL
   1087  1.6  christos 	  && s->size >= 24
   1088  1.6  christos 	  && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
   1089  1.6  christos 	{
   1090  1.6  christos 	  unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
   1091  1.6  christos 	  unsigned int i;
   1092  1.6  christos 
   1093  1.6  christos 	  for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
   1094  1.6  christos 	    {
   1095  1.6  christos 	      unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
   1096  1.6  christos 	      switch (val >> 16)
   1097  1.6  christos 		{
   1098  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
   1099  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
   1100  1.6  christos 		  if (mach == 0)
   1101  1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
   1102  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1103  1.6  christos 
   1104  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
   1105  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
   1106  1.6  christos 		  if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
   1107  1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
   1108  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1109  1.6  christos 
   1110  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
   1111  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
   1112  1.7  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
   1113  1.6  christos 		  if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
   1114  1.6  christos 		    mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
   1115  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1116  1.6  christos 
   1117  1.6  christos 		case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
   1118  1.6  christos 		  mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
   1119  1.6  christos 		  break;
   1120  1.6  christos 
   1121  1.6  christos 		default:
   1122  1.6  christos 		  mach = -1ul;
   1123  1.6  christos 		}
   1124  1.6  christos 	    }
   1125  1.6  christos 	  free (contents);
   1126  1.6  christos 	}
   1127  1.6  christos     }
   1128  1.6  christos 
   1129  1.6  christos   if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
   1130  1.6  christos     {
   1131  1.6  christos       const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
   1132  1.6  christos 
   1133  1.6  christos       for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
   1134  1.6  christos 	if (arch->mach == mach)
   1135  1.6  christos 	  {
   1136  1.6  christos 	    abfd->arch_info = arch;
   1137  1.6  christos 	    break;
   1138  1.6  christos 	  }
   1139  1.6  christos     }
   1140  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1141  1.6  christos }
   1142  1.1  christos 
   1143  1.1  christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
   1144  1.1  christos    default is 64 bit.  Also select arch based on apuinfo.  */
   1145  1.1  christos 
   1146  1.6  christos static bfd_boolean
   1147  1.6  christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
   1148  1.6  christos {
   1149  1.6  christos   if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
   1150  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   1151  1.1  christos 
   1152  1.1  christos   if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
   1153  1.1  christos     {
   1154  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
   1155  1.1  christos 
   1156  1.1  christos       if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
   1157  1.1  christos 	{
   1158  1.1  christos 	  /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default.  */
   1159  1.1  christos 	  abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
   1160  1.6  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
   1161  1.1  christos 	}
   1162  1.1  christos     }
   1163  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
   1164  1.1  christos }
   1165  1.1  christos 
   1166  1.1  christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set.  */
   1167  1.1  christos 
   1168  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1169  1.1  christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
   1170  1.1  christos {
   1171  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
   1172  1.1  christos 	      || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
   1173  1.1  christos 
   1174  1.1  christos   elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
   1175  1.1  christos   elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
   1176  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1177  1.1  christos }
   1178  1.1  christos 
   1179  1.1  christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections.  */
   1180  1.1  christos 
   1181  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1182  1.1  christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1183  1.1  christos {
   1184  1.1  christos   int offset;
   1185  1.1  christos   unsigned int size;
   1186  1.1  christos 
   1187  1.1  christos   switch (note->descsz)
   1188  1.1  christos     {
   1189  1.1  christos     default:
   1190  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   1191  1.1  christos 
   1192  1.1  christos     case 268:		/* Linux/PPC.  */
   1193  1.1  christos       /* pr_cursig */
   1194  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
   1195  1.1  christos 
   1196  1.1  christos       /* pr_pid */
   1197  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
   1198  1.1  christos 
   1199  1.1  christos       /* pr_reg */
   1200  1.1  christos       offset = 72;
   1201  1.1  christos       size = 192;
   1202  1.1  christos 
   1203  1.1  christos       break;
   1204  1.1  christos     }
   1205  1.1  christos 
   1206  1.1  christos   /* Make a ".reg/999" section.  */
   1207  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
   1208  1.1  christos 					  size, note->descpos + offset);
   1209  1.1  christos }
   1210  1.1  christos 
   1211  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1212  1.1  christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
   1213  1.1  christos {
   1214  1.1  christos   switch (note->descsz)
   1215  1.1  christos     {
   1216  1.1  christos     default:
   1217  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   1218  1.1  christos 
   1219  1.1  christos     case 128:		/* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo.  */
   1220  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
   1221  1.1  christos 	= bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
   1222  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
   1223  1.1  christos 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
   1224  1.1  christos       elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
   1225  1.1  christos 	= _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
   1226  1.1  christos     }
   1227  1.1  christos 
   1228  1.1  christos   /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
   1229  1.1  christos      onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
   1230  1.1  christos      implementations, so strip it off if it exists.  */
   1231  1.1  christos 
   1232  1.1  christos   {
   1233  1.1  christos     char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
   1234  1.1  christos     int n = strlen (command);
   1235  1.1  christos 
   1236  1.1  christos     if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
   1237  1.1  christos       command[n - 1] = '\0';
   1238  1.1  christos   }
   1239  1.1  christos 
   1240  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1241  1.1  christos }
   1242  1.1  christos 
   1243  1.1  christos static char *
   1244  1.1  christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
   1245  1.1  christos {
   1246  1.1  christos   switch (note_type)
   1247  1.1  christos     {
   1248  1.1  christos     default:
   1249  1.1  christos       return NULL;
   1250  1.8  christos 
   1251  1.1  christos     case NT_PRPSINFO:
   1252  1.1  christos       {
   1253  1.1  christos 	char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
   1254  1.1  christos 	va_list ap;
   1255  1.1  christos 
   1256  1.8  christos 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1257  1.8  christos 	memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
   1258  1.8  christos 	strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
   1259  1.8  christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1260  1.8  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
   1261  1.8  christos 	/* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
   1262  1.8  christos 	   -Wstringop-truncation:
   1263  1.8  christos 	   https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
   1264  1.1  christos 	 */
   1265  1.8  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
   1266  1.8  christos #endif
   1267  1.8  christos 	strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
   1268  1.1  christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
   1269  1.1  christos 	DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
   1270  1.1  christos #endif
   1271  1.1  christos 	va_end (ap);
   1272  1.1  christos 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1273  1.1  christos 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1274  1.1  christos       }
   1275  1.1  christos 
   1276  1.1  christos     case NT_PRSTATUS:
   1277  1.1  christos       {
   1278  1.1  christos 	char data[268];
   1279  1.1  christos 	va_list ap;
   1280  1.1  christos 	long pid;
   1281  1.1  christos 	int cursig;
   1282  1.1  christos 	const void *greg;
   1283  1.1  christos 
   1284  1.1  christos 	va_start (ap, note_type);
   1285  1.1  christos 	memset (data, 0, 72);
   1286  1.1  christos 	pid = va_arg (ap, long);
   1287  1.1  christos 	bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
   1288  1.1  christos 	cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
   1289  1.1  christos 	bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
   1290  1.1  christos 	greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
   1291  1.1  christos 	memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
   1292  1.1  christos 	memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
   1293  1.1  christos 	va_end (ap);
   1294  1.1  christos 	return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
   1295  1.1  christos 				   "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
   1296  1.1  christos       }
   1297  1.1  christos     }
   1298  1.1  christos }
   1299  1.1  christos 
   1300  1.1  christos static flagword
   1301  1.1  christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
   1302  1.1  christos {
   1303  1.1  christos 
   1304  1.1  christos   if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
   1305  1.1  christos     return SHF_PPC_VLE;
   1306  1.1  christos 
   1307  1.1  christos   return 0;
   1308  1.1  christos }
   1309  1.1  christos 
   1310  1.1  christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
   1311  1.1  christos    or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included.  */
   1312  1.1  christos 
   1313  1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   1314  1.1  christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1315  1.1  christos 		     const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1316  1.1  christos 		     const arelent *rel)
   1317  1.1  christos {
   1318  1.1  christos   return rel->address;
   1319  1.1  christos }
   1320  1.1  christos 
   1321  1.1  christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file.  This
   1322  1.1  christos    is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
   1323  1.1  christos    type.  */
   1324  1.1  christos 
   1325  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1326  1.1  christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
   1327  1.1  christos 			   Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
   1328  1.1  christos 			   const char *name,
   1329  1.1  christos 			   int shindex)
   1330  1.1  christos {
   1331  1.1  christos   asection *newsect;
   1332  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   1333  1.1  christos 
   1334  1.1  christos   if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
   1335  1.9  christos     return FALSE;
   1336  1.1  christos 
   1337  1.1  christos   newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
   1338  1.1  christos   flags = 0;
   1339  1.1  christos   if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
   1340  1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   1341  1.1  christos 
   1342  1.9  christos   if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
   1343  1.9  christos     flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
   1344  1.9  christos 
   1345  1.9  christos   if (strncmp (name, ".PPC.EMB", 8) == 0)
   1346  1.9  christos     name += 8;
   1347  1.9  christos   if (strncmp (name, ".sbss", 5) == 0
   1348  1.9  christos       || strncmp (name, ".sdata", 6) == 0)
   1349  1.9  christos     flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
   1350  1.1  christos 
   1351  1.1  christos   return (flags == 0
   1352  1.1  christos 	  || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
   1353  1.1  christos }
   1354  1.1  christos 
   1355  1.1  christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary.  */
   1356  1.1  christos 
   1357  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1358  1.1  christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1359  1.1  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
   1360  1.1  christos 		       asection *asect)
   1361  1.1  christos {
   1362  1.1  christos   if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
   1363  1.1  christos     shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
   1364  1.1  christos 
   1365  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1366  1.1  christos }
   1367  1.1  christos 
   1368  1.1  christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
   1369  1.1  christos    need to bump up the number of section headers.  */
   1370  1.1  christos 
   1371  1.1  christos static int
   1372  1.1  christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
   1373  1.1  christos 				    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1374  1.1  christos {
   1375  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   1376  1.1  christos   int ret = 0;
   1377  1.1  christos 
   1378  1.1  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
   1379  1.1  christos   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1380  1.1  christos     ++ret;
   1381  1.1  christos 
   1382  1.1  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
   1383  1.1  christos   if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
   1384  1.1  christos     ++ret;
   1385  1.1  christos 
   1386  1.1  christos   return ret;
   1387  1.1  christos }
   1388  1.1  christos 
   1389  1.1  christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables.  */
   1390  1.1  christos 
   1391  1.1  christos bfd_boolean
   1392  1.7  christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
   1393  1.1  christos 			    struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1394  1.1  christos {
   1395  1.1  christos   struct elf_segment_map *m;
   1396  1.1  christos 
   1397  1.1  christos   /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
   1398  1.1  christos      LMA and assigned to segments.  All that is left to do is to ensure
   1399  1.1  christos      there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
   1400  1.1  christos      If we find that case, we split the segment.
   1401  1.1  christos      We maintain the original output section order.  */
   1402  1.7  christos 
   1403  1.9  christos   for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
   1404  1.7  christos     {
   1405  1.7  christos       struct elf_segment_map *n;
   1406  1.7  christos       size_t amt;
   1407  1.7  christos       unsigned int j, k;
   1408  1.1  christos       unsigned int p_flags;
   1409  1.1  christos 
   1410  1.7  christos       if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
   1411  1.1  christos 	continue;
   1412  1.7  christos 
   1413  1.7  christos       for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
   1414  1.7  christos 	{
   1415  1.7  christos 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1416  1.7  christos 	    p_flags |= PF_W;
   1417  1.7  christos 	  if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1418  1.7  christos 	    {
   1419  1.7  christos 	      p_flags |= PF_X;
   1420  1.7  christos 	      if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1421  1.7  christos 		p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1422  1.7  christos 	      break;
   1423  1.7  christos 	    }
   1424  1.7  christos 	}
   1425  1.7  christos       if (j != m->count)
   1426  1.1  christos 	while (++j != m->count)
   1427  1.7  christos 	  {
   1428  1.7  christos 	    unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
   1429  1.7  christos 
   1430  1.7  christos 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
   1431  1.7  christos 	      p_flags1 |= PF_W;
   1432  1.7  christos 	    if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   1433  1.7  christos 	      {
   1434  1.7  christos 		p_flags1 |= PF_X;
   1435  1.7  christos 		if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1436  1.7  christos 		  p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
   1437  1.7  christos 		if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
   1438  1.7  christos 		  break;
   1439  1.7  christos 	      }
   1440  1.7  christos 	    p_flags |= p_flags1;
   1441  1.7  christos 	  }
   1442  1.7  christos       /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
   1443  1.7  christos 	 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
   1444  1.7  christos 	 two parts.  So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
   1445  1.7  christos 	 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set.  */
   1446  1.7  christos       if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
   1447  1.7  christos 	{
   1448  1.7  christos 	  m->p_flags_valid = 1;
   1449  1.1  christos 	  m->p_flags = p_flags;
   1450  1.1  christos 	}
   1451  1.7  christos       if (j == m->count)
   1452  1.1  christos 	continue;
   1453  1.1  christos 
   1454  1.1  christos       /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
   1455  1.1  christos 	 the remainder are put in a new segment.
   1456  1.1  christos 	 The scan resumes with the new segment.  */
   1457  1.1  christos 
   1458  1.1  christos       amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
   1459  1.8  christos       amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
   1460  1.1  christos       n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   1461  1.1  christos       if (n == NULL)
   1462  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   1463  1.1  christos 
   1464  1.7  christos       n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
   1465  1.7  christos       n->count = m->count - j;
   1466  1.7  christos       for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
   1467  1.1  christos 	n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
   1468  1.1  christos       m->count = j;
   1469  1.1  christos       m->p_size_valid = 0;
   1470  1.1  christos       n->next = m->next;
   1471  1.1  christos       m->next = n;
   1472  1.1  christos     }
   1473  1.1  christos 
   1474  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   1475  1.1  christos }
   1476  1.1  christos 
   1477  1.1  christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
   1478  1.1  christos    .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
   1479  1.1  christos    that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
   1480  1.1  christos    2 sections.  */
   1481  1.6  christos 
   1482  1.6  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
   1483  1.6  christos {
   1484  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
   1485  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1486  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1487  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
   1488  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1489  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
   1490  1.6  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
   1491  1.1  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1492  1.1  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
   1493  1.1  christos   { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
   1494  1.1  christos };
   1495  1.8  christos 
   1496  1.1  christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got.  */
   1497  1.1  christos static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
   1498  1.7  christos   { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"),		   0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
   1499  1.1  christos 
   1500  1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   1501  1.1  christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   1502  1.1  christos {
   1503  1.1  christos   const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
   1504  1.1  christos 
   1505  1.1  christos   /* See if this is one of the special sections.  */
   1506  1.1  christos   if (sec->name == NULL)
   1507  1.1  christos     return NULL;
   1508  1.1  christos 
   1509  1.1  christos   ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
   1510  1.1  christos 					sec->use_rela_p);
   1511  1.1  christos   if (ssect != NULL)
   1512  1.1  christos     {
   1513  1.1  christos       if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
   1514  1.1  christos 	ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
   1515  1.1  christos       return ssect;
   1516  1.1  christos     }
   1517  1.1  christos 
   1518  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   1519  1.1  christos }
   1520  1.1  christos 
   1521  1.1  christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values.  */
   1523  1.1  christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
   1524  1.1  christos {
   1525  1.1  christos   struct apuinfo_list *next;
   1526  1.1  christos   unsigned long value;
   1527  1.1  christos }
   1528  1.1  christos apuinfo_list;
   1529  1.1  christos 
   1530  1.1  christos static apuinfo_list *head;
   1531  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
   1532  1.1  christos 
   1533  1.1  christos static void
   1534  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
   1535  1.1  christos {
   1536  1.1  christos   head = NULL;
   1537  1.1  christos   apuinfo_set = FALSE;
   1538  1.1  christos }
   1539  1.1  christos 
   1540  1.1  christos static void
   1541  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
   1542  1.1  christos {
   1543  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry = head;
   1544  1.1  christos 
   1545  1.1  christos   while (entry != NULL)
   1546  1.1  christos     {
   1547  1.1  christos       if (entry->value == value)
   1548  1.1  christos 	return;
   1549  1.1  christos       entry = entry->next;
   1550  1.1  christos     }
   1551  1.1  christos 
   1552  1.1  christos   entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
   1553  1.1  christos   if (entry == NULL)
   1554  1.1  christos     return;
   1555  1.1  christos 
   1556  1.1  christos   entry->value = value;
   1557  1.1  christos   entry->next  = head;
   1558  1.1  christos   head = entry;
   1559  1.1  christos }
   1560  1.1  christos 
   1561  1.1  christos static unsigned
   1562  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
   1563  1.1  christos {
   1564  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1565  1.1  christos   unsigned long count;
   1566  1.1  christos 
   1567  1.1  christos   for (entry = head, count = 0;
   1568  1.1  christos        entry;
   1569  1.1  christos        entry = entry->next)
   1570  1.1  christos     ++ count;
   1571  1.1  christos 
   1572  1.1  christos   return count;
   1573  1.1  christos }
   1574  1.1  christos 
   1575  1.1  christos static inline unsigned long
   1576  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
   1577  1.1  christos {
   1578  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list * entry;
   1579  1.1  christos 
   1580  1.1  christos   for (entry = head;
   1581  1.1  christos        entry && number --;
   1582  1.1  christos        entry = entry->next)
   1583  1.1  christos     ;
   1584  1.1  christos 
   1585  1.1  christos   return entry ? entry->value : 0;
   1586  1.1  christos }
   1587  1.1  christos 
   1588  1.1  christos static void
   1589  1.1  christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
   1590  1.1  christos {
   1591  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list *entry;
   1592  1.1  christos 
   1593  1.1  christos   for (entry = head; entry;)
   1594  1.1  christos     {
   1595  1.1  christos       apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
   1596  1.1  christos       free (entry);
   1597  1.1  christos       entry = next;
   1598  1.1  christos     }
   1599  1.1  christos 
   1600  1.1  christos   head = NULL;
   1601  1.1  christos }
   1602  1.1  christos 
   1603  1.1  christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
   1604  1.1  christos    the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted.  */
   1605  1.1  christos 
   1606  1.1  christos static void
   1607  1.1  christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
   1608  1.1  christos {
   1609  1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   1610  1.1  christos   asection *asec;
   1611  1.1  christos   char *buffer = NULL;
   1612  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
   1613  1.1  christos   unsigned i;
   1614  1.1  christos   unsigned long length;
   1615  1.1  christos   const char *error_message = NULL;
   1616  1.1  christos 
   1617  1.1  christos   if (link_info == NULL)
   1618  1.1  christos     return;
   1619  1.3  christos 
   1620  1.1  christos   apuinfo_list_init ();
   1621  1.1  christos 
   1622  1.1  christos   /* Read in the input sections contents.  */
   1623  1.1  christos   for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   1624  1.1  christos     {
   1625  1.1  christos       unsigned long datum;
   1626  1.1  christos 
   1627  1.7  christos       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1628  1.8  christos       if (asec == NULL)
   1629  1.1  christos 	continue;
   1630  1.1  christos 
   1631  1.1  christos       /* xgettext:c-format */
   1632  1.1  christos       error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
   1633  1.1  christos       length = asec->size;
   1634  1.1  christos       if (length < 20)
   1635  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1636  1.9  christos 
   1637  1.1  christos       apuinfo_set = TRUE;
   1638  1.1  christos       if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
   1639  1.1  christos 	{
   1640  1.1  christos 	  free (buffer);
   1641  1.1  christos 	  largest_input_size = asec->size;
   1642  1.1  christos 	  buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
   1643  1.1  christos 	  if (!buffer)
   1644  1.1  christos 	    return;
   1645  1.1  christos 	}
   1646  1.7  christos 
   1647  1.8  christos       if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
   1648  1.1  christos 	  || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
   1649  1.1  christos 	{
   1650  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1651  1.1  christos 	  error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
   1652  1.1  christos 	  goto fail;
   1653  1.1  christos 	}
   1654  1.1  christos 
   1655  1.1  christos       /* Verify the contents of the header.  Note - we have to
   1656  1.1  christos 	 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
   1657  1.1  christos 	 host whose endian-ness is different from the target.  */
   1658  1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
   1659  1.1  christos       if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
   1660  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1661  1.1  christos 
   1662  1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
   1663  1.1  christos       if (datum != 0x2)
   1664  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1665  1.1  christos 
   1666  1.1  christos       if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
   1667  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1668  1.1  christos 
   1669  1.1  christos       /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries.  */
   1670  1.1  christos       datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
   1671  1.1  christos       if (datum + 20 != length)
   1672  1.1  christos 	goto fail;
   1673  1.1  christos 
   1674  1.1  christos       /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers.  */
   1675  1.1  christos       for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
   1676  1.1  christos 	apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
   1677  1.1  christos     }
   1678  1.1  christos 
   1679  1.1  christos   error_message = NULL;
   1680  1.1  christos 
   1681  1.1  christos   if (apuinfo_set)
   1682  1.1  christos     {
   1683  1.1  christos       /* Compute the size of the output section.  */
   1684  1.1  christos       unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1685  1.9  christos 
   1686  1.1  christos       /* Set the output section size, if it exists.  */
   1687  1.1  christos       asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1688  1.7  christos 
   1689  1.8  christos       if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
   1690  1.1  christos 	{
   1691  1.1  christos 	  ibfd = abfd;
   1692  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   1693  1.1  christos 	  error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
   1694  1.9  christos 	}
   1695  1.1  christos     }
   1696  1.1  christos 
   1697  1.8  christos  fail:
   1698  1.1  christos   free (buffer);
   1699  1.1  christos 
   1700  1.1  christos   if (error_message)
   1701  1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
   1702  1.1  christos }
   1703  1.1  christos 
   1704  1.1  christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
   1705  1.1  christos    contents.  We have already stored this in our linked list structure.  */
   1706  1.1  christos 
   1707  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1708  1.1  christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1709  1.1  christos 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   1710  1.1  christos 		       asection *asec,
   1711  1.1  christos 		       bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
   1712  1.1  christos {
   1713  1.1  christos   return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
   1714  1.1  christos }
   1715  1.9  christos 
   1716  1.1  christos /* Finally we can generate the output section.  */
   1717  1.1  christos 
   1718  1.1  christos static void
   1719  1.1  christos ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   1720  1.1  christos {
   1721  1.1  christos   bfd_byte *buffer;
   1722  1.1  christos   asection *asec;
   1723  1.1  christos   unsigned i;
   1724  1.1  christos   unsigned num_entries;
   1725  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type length;
   1726  1.1  christos 
   1727  1.1  christos   asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
   1728  1.1  christos   if (asec == NULL)
   1729  1.1  christos     return;
   1730  1.1  christos 
   1731  1.1  christos   if (!apuinfo_set)
   1732  1.1  christos     return;
   1733  1.1  christos 
   1734  1.1  christos   length = asec->size;
   1735  1.1  christos   if (length < 20)
   1736  1.1  christos     return;
   1737  1.7  christos 
   1738  1.8  christos   buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
   1739  1.1  christos   if (buffer == NULL)
   1740  1.1  christos     {
   1741  1.1  christos       _bfd_error_handler
   1742  1.1  christos 	(_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
   1743  1.1  christos       return;
   1744  1.1  christos     }
   1745  1.1  christos 
   1746  1.1  christos   /* Create the apuinfo header.  */
   1747  1.1  christos   num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
   1748  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
   1749  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
   1750  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
   1751  1.1  christos   strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
   1752  1.1  christos 
   1753  1.1  christos   length = 20;
   1754  1.1  christos   for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
   1755  1.1  christos     {
   1756  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
   1757  1.8  christos       length += 4;
   1758  1.1  christos     }
   1759  1.1  christos 
   1760  1.8  christos   if (length != asec->size)
   1761  1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
   1762  1.1  christos 
   1763  1.1  christos   if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
   1764  1.1  christos     _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
   1765  1.1  christos 
   1766  1.9  christos   free (buffer);
   1767  1.9  christos 
   1768  1.9  christos   apuinfo_list_finish ();
   1769  1.9  christos }
   1770  1.9  christos 
   1771  1.9  christos static bfd_boolean
   1772  1.9  christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   1773  1.1  christos {
   1774  1.1  christos   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
   1775  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
   1776  1.1  christos }
   1777  1.8  christos 
   1778  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1780  1.1  christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
   1781  1.1  christos {
   1782  1.1  christos   bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
   1783  1.1  christos 
   1784  1.1  christos   if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
   1785  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   1786  1.1  christos 
   1787  1.1  christos   return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
   1788  1.1  christos 	  && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
   1789  1.1  christos 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
   1790  1.1  christos 	  && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
   1791  1.1  christos }
   1792  1.1  christos 
   1793  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   1794  1.1  christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
   1795  1.1  christos {
   1796  1.1  christos   bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
   1797  1.1  christos   return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
   1798  1.1  christos 	  && section->vma <= vma
   1799  1.1  christos 	  && vma < section->vma + section->size);
   1800  1.1  christos }
   1801  1.1  christos 
   1802  1.1  christos static long
   1803  1.1  christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
   1804  1.1  christos 			      long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
   1805  1.1  christos 			      asymbol **ret)
   1806  1.8  christos {
   1807  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
   1808  1.1  christos   asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
   1809  1.9  christos   bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
   1810  1.1  christos   bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
   1811  1.1  christos   bfd_vma stub_off;
   1812  1.1  christos   asymbol *s;
   1813  1.1  christos   arelent *p;
   1814  1.1  christos   size_t count, i, stub_delta;
   1815  1.1  christos   size_t size;
   1816  1.1  christos   char *names;
   1817  1.1  christos   bfd_byte buf[4];
   1818  1.1  christos 
   1819  1.1  christos   *ret = NULL;
   1820  1.1  christos 
   1821  1.1  christos   if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
   1822  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1823  1.1  christos 
   1824  1.1  christos   if (dynsymcount <= 0)
   1825  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1826  1.1  christos 
   1827  1.1  christos   relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
   1828  1.1  christos   if (relplt == NULL)
   1829  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1830  1.1  christos 
   1831  1.1  christos   plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
   1832  1.1  christos   if (plt == NULL)
   1833  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1834  1.1  christos 
   1835  1.1  christos   /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs.  */
   1836  1.1  christos   if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
   1837  1.1  christos     return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
   1838  1.1  christos 					  dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
   1839  1.1  christos 
   1840  1.1  christos   /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
   1841  1.1  christos      of .glink at got[1].  If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero.  */
   1842  1.1  christos   dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
   1843  1.1  christos   if (dynamic != NULL)
   1844  1.1  christos     {
   1845  1.1  christos       bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
   1846  1.1  christos       size_t extdynsize;
   1847  1.1  christos       void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
   1848  1.1  christos 
   1849  1.1  christos       if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
   1850  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   1851  1.1  christos 
   1852  1.1  christos       extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
   1853  1.1  christos       swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
   1854  1.1  christos 
   1855  1.1  christos       extdyn = dynbuf;
   1856  1.1  christos       extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
   1857  1.1  christos       for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
   1858  1.1  christos 	{
   1859  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   1860  1.1  christos 	  (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
   1861  1.1  christos 
   1862  1.1  christos 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
   1863  1.1  christos 	    break;
   1864  1.1  christos 
   1865  1.1  christos 	  if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
   1866  1.1  christos 	    {
   1867  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
   1868  1.1  christos 	      asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
   1869  1.1  christos 	      if (got != NULL
   1870  1.1  christos 		  && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
   1871  1.1  christos 					       g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
   1872  1.1  christos 		glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1873  1.1  christos 	      break;
   1874  1.1  christos 	    }
   1875  1.1  christos 	}
   1876  1.1  christos       free (dynbuf);
   1877  1.1  christos     }
   1878  1.1  christos 
   1879  1.1  christos   /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry.  */
   1880  1.1  christos   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1881  1.1  christos     {
   1882  1.1  christos       if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
   1883  1.1  christos 	glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1884  1.1  christos     }
   1885  1.1  christos 
   1886  1.1  christos   if (glink_vma == 0)
   1887  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1888  1.1  christos 
   1889  1.1  christos   /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
   1890  1.1  christos      link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
   1891  1.1  christos      glink stubs now reside.  */
   1892  1.1  christos   glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
   1893  1.1  christos   if (glink == NULL)
   1894  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1895  1.1  christos 
   1896  1.1  christos   /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
   1897  1.1  christos      from the first glink stub.  */
   1898  1.1  christos   if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1899  1.1  christos 				glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
   1900  1.1  christos     {
   1901  1.1  christos       unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
   1902  1.1  christos 
   1903  1.1  christos       /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ...  */
   1904  1.1  christos       insn ^= B;
   1905  1.1  christos       if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
   1906  1.1  christos 	resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
   1907  1.1  christos 
   1908  1.1  christos       /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs.  */
   1909  1.1  christos       else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
   1910  1.1  christos 	for (i = 4;
   1911  1.1  christos 	     bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
   1912  1.1  christos 				       glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
   1913  1.1  christos 	     i += 4)
   1914  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
   1915  1.1  christos 	    {
   1916  1.1  christos 	      resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
   1917  1.1  christos 	      break;
   1918  1.1  christos 	    }
   1919  1.1  christos     }
   1920  1.8  christos 
   1921  1.8  christos   count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   1922  1.8  christos   /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
   1923  1.8  christos      multiple stubs for each plt entry.  If that is the case then
   1924  1.8  christos      there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
   1925  1.8  christos      of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
   1926  1.8  christos      The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
   1927  1.8  christos      GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   1928  1.1  christos   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1929  1.1  christos   for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
   1930  1.1  christos     if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
   1931  1.1  christos       break;
   1932  1.1  christos   if (stub_delta > 32)
   1933  1.1  christos     return 0;
   1934  1.1  christos 
   1935  1.1  christos   slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
   1936  1.1  christos   if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
   1937  1.1  christos     return -1;
   1938  1.1  christos 
   1939  1.1  christos   size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
   1940  1.1  christos   p = relplt->relocation;
   1941  1.1  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
   1942  1.1  christos     {
   1943  1.1  christos       size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
   1944  1.1  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   1945  1.1  christos 	size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
   1946  1.1  christos     }
   1947  1.1  christos 
   1948  1.1  christos   size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
   1949  1.1  christos 
   1950  1.1  christos   if (resolv_vma)
   1951  1.1  christos     size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   1952  1.8  christos 
   1953  1.1  christos   s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
   1954  1.5  christos   if (s == NULL)
   1955  1.5  christos     return -1;
   1956  1.1  christos 
   1957  1.1  christos   stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1958  1.1  christos   names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
   1959  1.8  christos   p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
   1960  1.8  christos   for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
   1961  1.8  christos     {
   1962  1.1  christos       size_t len;
   1963  1.1  christos 
   1964  1.1  christos       stub_off -= stub_delta;
   1965  1.1  christos       if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
   1966  1.1  christos 	stub_off -= 32;
   1967  1.1  christos       *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
   1968  1.1  christos       /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set.  Since
   1969  1.8  christos 	 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set.  */
   1970  1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
   1971  1.1  christos 	s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
   1972  1.1  christos       s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1973  1.1  christos       s->section = glink;
   1974  1.1  christos       s->value = stub_off;
   1975  1.1  christos       s->name = names;
   1976  1.1  christos       s->udata.p = NULL;
   1977  1.1  christos       len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
   1978  1.1  christos       memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
   1979  1.1  christos       names += len;
   1980  1.1  christos       if (p->addend != 0)
   1981  1.1  christos 	{
   1982  1.1  christos 	  memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
   1983  1.1  christos 	  names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
   1984  1.1  christos 	  bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
   1985  1.5  christos 	  names += strlen (names);
   1986  1.1  christos 	}
   1987  1.1  christos       memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
   1988  1.1  christos       names += sizeof ("@plt");
   1989  1.1  christos       ++s;
   1990  1.1  christos       --p;
   1991  1.1  christos     }
   1992  1.1  christos 
   1993  1.1  christos   /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table.  */
   1994  1.1  christos   memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   1995  1.1  christos   s->the_bfd = abfd;
   1996  1.1  christos   s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   1997  1.1  christos   s->section = glink;
   1998  1.1  christos   s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
   1999  1.1  christos   s->name = names;
   2000  1.1  christos   memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
   2001  1.1  christos   names += sizeof ("__glink");
   2002  1.1  christos   s++;
   2003  1.1  christos   count++;
   2004  1.1  christos 
   2005  1.1  christos   if (resolv_vma)
   2006  1.1  christos     {
   2007  1.1  christos       /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver.  */
   2008  1.1  christos       memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
   2009  1.1  christos       s->the_bfd = abfd;
   2010  1.1  christos       s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
   2011  1.1  christos       s->section = glink;
   2012  1.1  christos       s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
   2013  1.1  christos       s->name = names;
   2014  1.1  christos       memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
   2015  1.1  christos       names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
   2016  1.1  christos       s++;
   2017  1.1  christos       count++;
   2018  1.1  christos     }
   2019  1.1  christos 
   2020  1.1  christos   return count;
   2021  1.1  christos }
   2022  1.1  christos 
   2023  1.1  christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
   2025  1.1  christos    functions above are used generally.  They appear in this file more
   2026  1.1  christos    or less in the order in which they are called.  eg.
   2027  1.1  christos    ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
   2028  1.1  christos    ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
   2029  1.1  christos    called.  */
   2030  1.1  christos 
   2031  1.1  christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol.  We might need more
   2032  1.1  christos    than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary.  */
   2033  1.1  christos struct plt_entry
   2034  1.1  christos {
   2035  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *next;
   2036  1.1  christos 
   2037  1.1  christos   /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
   2038  1.1  christos      This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
   2039  1.1  christos      GOT pointer reg.  It will always be at least 32768.  (Current
   2040  1.1  christos      gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
   2041  1.1  christos      sections together resulting in larger offsets).  */
   2042  1.1  christos   bfd_vma addend;
   2043  1.1  christos 
   2044  1.1  christos   /* The .got2 section.  */
   2045  1.1  christos   asection *sec;
   2046  1.1  christos 
   2047  1.1  christos   /* PLT refcount or offset.  */
   2048  1.1  christos   union
   2049  1.1  christos     {
   2050  1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2051  1.1  christos       bfd_vma offset;
   2052  1.8  christos     } plt;
   2053  1.8  christos 
   2054  1.8  christos   /* .glink stub offset.  */
   2055  1.1  christos   bfd_vma glink_offset;
   2056  1.1  christos };
   2057  1.1  christos 
   2058  1.1  christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
   2059  1.1  christos    function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
   2060  1.1  christos    library or PIE, even when the symbol is local.  */
   2061  1.1  christos 
   2062  1.1  christos static int
   2063  1.8  christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2064  1.8  christos 		   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2065  1.8  christos {
   2066  1.8  christos   switch (r_type)
   2067  1.1  christos     {
   2068  1.1  christos     default:
   2069  1.1  christos       /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
   2070  1.1  christos 	 address isn't fixed.  DTPREL32 is excluded because the
   2071  1.1  christos 	 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
   2072  1.1  christos 	 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set.  */
   2073  1.1  christos       return 1;
   2074  1.1  christos 
   2075  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL24:
   2076  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14:
   2077  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   2078  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   2079  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_REL32:
   2080  1.1  christos       return 0;
   2081  1.8  christos 
   2082  1.8  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   2083  1.8  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   2084  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   2085  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   2086  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   2087  1.1  christos       /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
   2088  1.1  christos 	 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base.  */
   2089  1.1  christos       return bfd_link_dll (info);
   2090  1.1  christos     }
   2091  1.1  christos }
   2092  1.1  christos 
   2093  1.1  christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
   2094  1.1  christos    copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
   2095  1.1  christos    section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
   2096  1.1  christos    shared lib.  */
   2097  1.1  christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
   2098  1.1  christos 
   2099  1.1  christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols.  */
   2100  1.1  christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
   2101  1.1  christos {
   2102  1.1  christos   struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
   2103  1.1  christos 
   2104  1.1  christos   /* The input section of the reloc.  */
   2105  1.1  christos   asection *sec;
   2106  1.1  christos 
   2107  1.1  christos   /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section.  */
   2108  1.1  christos   unsigned int count : 31;
   2109  1.1  christos 
   2110  1.1  christos   /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols.  */
   2111  1.1  christos   unsigned int ifunc : 1;
   2112  1.1  christos };
   2113  1.1  christos 
   2114  1.1  christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry.  */
   2115  1.1  christos 
   2116  1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
   2117  1.1  christos {
   2118  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
   2119  1.8  christos 
   2120  1.8  christos   /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
   2121  1.8  christos      specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
   2122  1.8  christos      from the beginning of the section.  */
   2123  1.8  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
   2124  1.8  christos 
   2125  1.9  christos   /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
   2126  1.8  christos      Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
   2127  1.8  christos      encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
   2128  1.8  christos      of the other TLS bits are set.  tls_optimize clears bits when
   2129  1.8  christos      optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
   2130  1.8  christos      needed.  If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared.  tls_optimize may also
   2131  1.8  christos      set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
   2132  1.8  christos      These flags are also kept for local symbols.  */
   2133  1.9  christos #define TLS_TLS		 1	/* Any TLS reloc.  */
   2134  1.8  christos #define TLS_GD		 2	/* GD reloc. */
   2135  1.8  christos #define TLS_LD		 4	/* LD reloc. */
   2136  1.8  christos #define TLS_TPREL	 8	/* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
   2137  1.8  christos #define TLS_DTPREL	16	/* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
   2138  1.8  christos #define TLS_MARK	32	/* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
   2139  1.8  christos #define TLS_GDIE	64	/* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
   2140  1.8  christos   unsigned char tls_mask;
   2141  1.1  christos 
   2142  1.1  christos   /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols.  In which
   2143  1.1  christos      case TLS_TLS will be 0.  */
   2144  1.5  christos #define PLT_IFUNC	 2	/* STT_GNU_IFUNC.  */
   2145  1.5  christos #define PLT_KEEP	 4	/* inline plt call requires plt entry.  */
   2146  1.5  christos #define NON_GOT        256	/* local symbol plt, not stored.  */
   2147  1.5  christos 
   2148  1.5  christos   /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
   2149  1.1  christos      symbol.  */
   2150  1.1  christos   unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
   2151  1.1  christos 
   2152  1.1  christos   /* Flag use of given relocations.  */
   2153  1.1  christos   unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
   2154  1.1  christos   unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
   2155  1.1  christos };
   2156  1.1  christos 
   2157  1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
   2158  1.1  christos 
   2159  1.3  christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2160  1.3  christos 
   2161  1.3  christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
   2162  1.1  christos {
   2163  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
   2164  1.1  christos 
   2165  1.1  christos   /* Various options passed from the linker.  */
   2166  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_params *params;
   2167  1.1  christos 
   2168  1.1  christos   /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections.  */
   2169  1.8  christos   asection *glink;
   2170  1.8  christos   asection *dynsbss;
   2171  1.1  christos   asection *relsbss;
   2172  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
   2173  1.1  christos   asection *sbss;
   2174  1.1  christos   asection *glink_eh_frame;
   2175  1.1  christos   asection *pltlocal;
   2176  1.1  christos   asection *relpltlocal;
   2177  1.1  christos 
   2178  1.1  christos   /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks.  */
   2179  1.1  christos   asection *srelplt2;
   2180  1.1  christos 
   2181  1.1  christos   /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr.  */
   2182  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
   2183  1.1  christos 
   2184  1.1  christos   /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT.  */
   2185  1.1  christos   bfd *old_bfd;
   2186  1.1  christos 
   2187  1.1  christos   /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling.  */
   2188  1.1  christos   union {
   2189  1.1  christos     bfd_signed_vma refcount;
   2190  1.1  christos     bfd_vma offset;
   2191  1.1  christos   } tlsld_got;
   2192  1.1  christos 
   2193  1.1  christos   /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink.  */
   2194  1.1  christos   bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
   2195  1.1  christos 
   2196  1.1  christos   /* Size of reserved GOT entries.  */
   2197  1.1  christos   unsigned int got_header_size;
   2198  1.7  christos   /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap.  */
   2199  1.7  christos   unsigned int got_gap;
   2200  1.7  christos 
   2201  1.7  christos   /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use.  */
   2202  1.7  christos   enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
   2203  1.8  christos 
   2204  1.8  christos   /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
   2205  1.8  christos      referenced by dynamic relocations.  */
   2206  1.8  christos   unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2207  1.8  christos   unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
   2208  1.8  christos 
   2209  1.1  christos   /* Set if tls optimization is enabled.  */
   2210  1.1  christos   unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
   2211  1.1  christos 
   2212  1.1  christos   /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls.  */
   2213  1.1  christos   unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
   2214  1.1  christos 
   2215  1.1  christos   /* The size of PLT entries.  */
   2216  1.1  christos   int plt_entry_size;
   2217  1.1  christos   /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots.  */
   2218  1.1  christos   int plt_slot_size;
   2219  1.1  christos   /* The size of the first PLT entry.  */
   2220  1.1  christos   int plt_initial_entry_size;
   2221  1.1  christos };
   2222  1.1  christos 
   2223  1.9  christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
   2224  1.9  christos    are used for ppc32.  The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects.  */
   2225  1.9  christos 
   2226  1.1  christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations.  */
   2227  1.8  christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
   2228  1.8  christos 
   2229  1.8  christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
   2230  1.1  christos    relocs.  */
   2231  1.1  christos #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
   2232  1.1  christos 
   2233  1.9  christos   /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected.  */
   2234  1.9  christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
   2235  1.9  christos 
   2236  1.1  christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure.  */
   2237  1.1  christos 
   2238  1.1  christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
   2239  1.1  christos   ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash)					\
   2240  1.1  christos     && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)	\
   2241  1.1  christos    ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
   2242  1.1  christos 
   2243  1.1  christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2244  1.1  christos 
   2245  1.1  christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
   2246  1.1  christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
   2247  1.1  christos 			   struct bfd_hash_table *table,
   2248  1.1  christos 			   const char *string)
   2249  1.1  christos {
   2250  1.1  christos   /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
   2251  1.1  christos      subclass.  */
   2252  1.1  christos   if (entry == NULL)
   2253  1.1  christos     {
   2254  1.1  christos       entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
   2255  1.1  christos 				 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
   2256  1.1  christos       if (entry == NULL)
   2257  1.1  christos 	return entry;
   2258  1.1  christos     }
   2259  1.1  christos 
   2260  1.1  christos   /* Call the allocation method of the superclass.  */
   2261  1.1  christos   entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
   2262  1.1  christos   if (entry != NULL)
   2263  1.1  christos     {
   2264  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
   2265  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
   2266  1.1  christos       ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
   2267  1.1  christos     }
   2268  1.1  christos 
   2269  1.1  christos   return entry;
   2270  1.1  christos }
   2271  1.1  christos 
   2272  1.6  christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table.  */
   2273  1.8  christos 
   2274  1.1  christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   2275  1.1  christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   2276  1.1  christos {
   2277  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
   2278  1.1  christos   static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
   2279  1.1  christos     = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
   2280  1.1  christos 
   2281  1.1  christos   ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
   2282  1.1  christos   if (ret == NULL)
   2283  1.1  christos     return NULL;
   2284  1.1  christos 
   2285  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
   2286  1.1  christos 				      ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
   2287  1.1  christos 				      sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
   2288  1.1  christos 				      PPC32_ELF_DATA))
   2289  1.1  christos     {
   2290  1.1  christos       free (ret);
   2291  1.1  christos       return NULL;
   2292  1.1  christos     }
   2293  1.3  christos 
   2294  1.3  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
   2295  1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
   2296  1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
   2297  1.1  christos   ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
   2298  1.1  christos 
   2299  1.1  christos   ret->params = &default_params;
   2300  1.1  christos 
   2301  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
   2302  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
   2303  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
   2304  1.1  christos 
   2305  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
   2306  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
   2307  1.1  christos   ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
   2308  1.1  christos 
   2309  1.1  christos   ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
   2310  1.3  christos   ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
   2311  1.3  christos   ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
   2312  1.3  christos 
   2313  1.3  christos   return &ret->elf.root;
   2314  1.3  christos }
   2315  1.3  christos 
   2316  1.3  christos /* Hook linker params into hash table.  */
   2317  1.3  christos 
   2318  1.3  christos void
   2319  1.6  christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
   2320  1.3  christos {
   2321  1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2322  1.1  christos 
   2323  1.1  christos   if (htab)
   2324  1.1  christos     htab->params = params;
   2325  1.1  christos   params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
   2326  1.1  christos }
   2327  1.1  christos 
   2328  1.1  christos /* Create .got and the related sections.  */
   2329  1.1  christos 
   2330  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2331  1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2332  1.1  christos {
   2333  1.9  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2334  1.1  christos 
   2335  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
   2336  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2337  1.7  christos 
   2338  1.7  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2339  1.9  christos   if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   2340  1.1  christos     {
   2341  1.1  christos       /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it.  Mark it
   2342  1.1  christos 	 executable.  */
   2343  1.1  christos       flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2344  1.1  christos 			| SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2345  1.1  christos       if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   2346  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   2347  1.3  christos     }
   2348  1.3  christos 
   2349  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   2350  1.3  christos }
   2351  1.3  christos 
   2352  1.3  christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
   2353  1.3  christos    R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers.  These sections become part of .sdata
   2354  1.3  christos    and .sdata2.  Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too.  */
   2355  1.3  christos 
   2356  1.3  christos static bfd_boolean
   2357  1.3  christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2358  1.3  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2359  1.3  christos 			       flagword flags,
   2360  1.3  christos 			       elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2361  1.3  christos {
   2362  1.3  christos   asection *s;
   2363  1.3  christos 
   2364  1.3  christos   flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
   2365  1.3  christos 	    | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2366  1.3  christos 
   2367  1.3  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
   2368  1.3  christos   if (s == NULL)
   2369  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   2370  1.3  christos   lsect->section = s;
   2371  1.3  christos 
   2372  1.3  christos   /* Define the sym on the first section of this name.  */
   2373  1.3  christos   s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
   2374  1.3  christos 
   2375  1.3  christos   lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
   2376  1.1  christos   if (lsect->sym == NULL)
   2377  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2378  1.1  christos   lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
   2379  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2380  1.1  christos }
   2381  1.1  christos 
   2382  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   2383  1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2384  1.1  christos {
   2385  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2386  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   2387  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   2388  1.8  christos   int p2align;
   2389  1.8  christos 
   2390  1.8  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2391  1.1  christos 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2392  1.9  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
   2393  1.1  christos   htab->glink = s;
   2394  1.1  christos   p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
   2395  1.1  christos   if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
   2396  1.1  christos     p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
   2397  1.1  christos   if (s == NULL
   2398  1.1  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
   2399  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2400  1.1  christos 
   2401  1.1  christos   if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
   2402  1.9  christos     {
   2403  1.1  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2404  1.1  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2405  1.1  christos       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
   2406  1.1  christos       htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
   2407  1.1  christos       if (s == NULL
   2408  1.7  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2409  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2410  1.9  christos     }
   2411  1.1  christos 
   2412  1.1  christos   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2413  1.1  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
   2414  1.1  christos   htab->elf.iplt = s;
   2415  1.1  christos   if (s == NULL
   2416  1.7  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
   2417  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2418  1.9  christos 
   2419  1.1  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2420  1.3  christos 	   | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2421  1.8  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
   2422  1.8  christos   htab->elf.irelplt = s;
   2423  1.8  christos   if (s == NULL
   2424  1.8  christos       || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2425  1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   2426  1.8  christos 
   2427  1.9  christos   /* Local plt entries.  */
   2428  1.8  christos   flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
   2429  1.8  christos 	   | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2430  1.8  christos   htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
   2431  1.8  christos 						       flags);
   2432  1.8  christos   if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
   2433  1.8  christos       || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
   2434  1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   2435  1.8  christos 
   2436  1.8  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   2437  1.9  christos     {
   2438  1.8  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
   2439  1.8  christos 	       | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2440  1.8  christos       htab->relpltlocal
   2441  1.3  christos 	= bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
   2442  1.3  christos       if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
   2443  1.3  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
   2444  1.3  christos 	return FALSE;
   2445  1.3  christos     }
   2446  1.3  christos 
   2447  1.3  christos   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
   2448  1.3  christos 				      &htab->sdata[0]))
   2449  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2450  1.1  christos 
   2451  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
   2452  1.1  christos 				      &htab->sdata[1]))
   2453  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2454  1.1  christos 
   2455  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2456  1.1  christos }
   2457  1.1  christos 
   2458  1.1  christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
   2459  1.1  christos    to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
   2460  1.1  christos    to create .dynbss and .rela.bss).  */
   2461  1.1  christos 
   2462  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2463  1.1  christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   2464  1.1  christos {
   2465  1.7  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2466  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   2467  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   2468  1.1  christos 
   2469  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2470  1.1  christos 
   2471  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2472  1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
   2473  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2474  1.1  christos 
   2475  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
   2476  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2477  1.1  christos 
   2478  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink == NULL
   2479  1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
   2480  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2481  1.1  christos 
   2482  1.6  christos   s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
   2483  1.1  christos 					  SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2484  1.1  christos   htab->dynsbss = s;
   2485  1.1  christos   if (s == NULL)
   2486  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2487  1.1  christos 
   2488  1.1  christos   if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   2489  1.9  christos     {
   2490  1.1  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   2491  1.1  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   2492  1.1  christos       s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
   2493  1.9  christos       htab->relsbss = s;
   2494  1.1  christos       if (s == NULL
   2495  1.1  christos 	  || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
   2496  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2497  1.7  christos     }
   2498  1.1  christos 
   2499  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   2500  1.1  christos       && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
   2501  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2502  1.9  christos 
   2503  1.1  christos   s = htab->elf.splt;
   2504  1.1  christos   flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2505  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   2506  1.1  christos     /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents.  */
   2507  1.1  christos     flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
   2508  1.1  christos   return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
   2509  1.1  christos }
   2510  1.1  christos 
   2511  1.1  christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry.  */
   2512  1.1  christos 
   2513  1.1  christos static void
   2514  1.1  christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2515  1.1  christos 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
   2516  1.1  christos 			      struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
   2517  1.1  christos {
   2518  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
   2519  1.1  christos 
   2520  1.7  christos   edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
   2521  1.7  christos   eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
   2522  1.1  christos 
   2523  1.1  christos   edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
   2524  1.8  christos   edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
   2525  1.1  christos 
   2526  1.1  christos   if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
   2527  1.1  christos     edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
   2528  1.8  christos   edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
   2529  1.8  christos   edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
   2530  1.8  christos   edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
   2531  1.8  christos   edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
   2532  1.9  christos   edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
   2533  1.1  christos 
   2534  1.9  christos   /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all.  */
   2535  1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   2536  1.1  christos     return;
   2537  1.1  christos 
   2538  1.1  christos   if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2539  1.1  christos     {
   2540  1.1  christos       if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   2541  1.9  christos 	{
   2542  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   2543  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   2544  1.1  christos 
   2545  1.9  christos 	  /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
   2546  1.1  christos 	     list.  Merge any entries against the same section.  */
   2547  1.1  christos 	  for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   2548  1.1  christos 	    {
   2549  1.1  christos 	      struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
   2550  1.1  christos 
   2551  1.1  christos 	      for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
   2552  1.1  christos 		if (q->sec == p->sec)
   2553  1.1  christos 		  {
   2554  1.1  christos 		    q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
   2555  1.1  christos 		    q->count += p->count;
   2556  1.9  christos 		    *pp = p->next;
   2557  1.1  christos 		    break;
   2558  1.1  christos 		  }
   2559  1.9  christos 	      if (q == NULL)
   2560  1.9  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   2561  1.1  christos 	    }
   2562  1.1  christos 	  *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
   2563  1.1  christos 	}
   2564  1.1  christos 
   2565  1.1  christos       dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
   2566  1.1  christos       ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   2567  1.1  christos     }
   2568  1.1  christos 
   2569  1.1  christos   /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
   2570  1.1  christos      the symbol which just became indirect.  */
   2571  1.1  christos   edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
   2572  1.1  christos   eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
   2573  1.1  christos 
   2574  1.1  christos   /* And plt entries.  */
   2575  1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2576  1.1  christos     {
   2577  1.1  christos       if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
   2578  1.1  christos 	{
   2579  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry **entp;
   2580  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   2581  1.1  christos 
   2582  1.1  christos 	  for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
   2583  1.1  christos 	    {
   2584  1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *dent;
   2585  1.1  christos 
   2586  1.1  christos 	      for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
   2587  1.1  christos 		if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
   2588  1.1  christos 		  {
   2589  1.1  christos 		    dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
   2590  1.1  christos 		    *entp = ent->next;
   2591  1.1  christos 		    break;
   2592  1.1  christos 		  }
   2593  1.1  christos 	      if (dent == NULL)
   2594  1.1  christos 		entp = &ent->next;
   2595  1.1  christos 	    }
   2596  1.1  christos 	  *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
   2597  1.1  christos 	}
   2598  1.1  christos 
   2599  1.1  christos       edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
   2600  1.1  christos       eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
   2601  1.1  christos     }
   2602  1.1  christos 
   2603  1.1  christos   if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2604  1.1  christos     {
   2605  1.1  christos       if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
   2606  1.1  christos 	_bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   2607  1.1  christos 				edir->elf.dynstr_index);
   2608  1.1  christos       edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
   2609  1.1  christos       edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
   2610  1.1  christos       eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
   2611  1.1  christos       eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
   2612  1.1  christos     }
   2613  1.1  christos }
   2614  1.1  christos 
   2615  1.1  christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
   2616  1.1  christos    file.  We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss.  */
   2617  1.1  christos 
   2618  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2619  1.1  christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   2620  1.1  christos 			 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2621  1.1  christos 			 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   2622  1.6  christos 			 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2623  1.1  christos 			 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   2624  1.1  christos 			 asection **secp,
   2625  1.1  christos 			 bfd_vma *valp)
   2626  1.1  christos {
   2627  1.1  christos   if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
   2628  1.1  christos       && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   2629  1.1  christos       && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
   2630  1.1  christos       && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
   2631  1.1  christos     {
   2632  1.1  christos       /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
   2633  1.9  christos 	 put into .sbss.  */
   2634  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2635  1.1  christos 
   2636  1.1  christos       htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2637  1.1  christos       if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2638  1.1  christos 	{
   2639  1.1  christos 	  flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
   2640  1.1  christos 
   2641  1.1  christos 	  if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
   2642  1.1  christos 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2643  1.1  christos 
   2644  1.1  christos 	  htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
   2645  1.1  christos 							   ".sbss",
   2646  1.1  christos 							   flags);
   2647  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->sbss == NULL)
   2648  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2649  1.1  christos 	}
   2650  1.1  christos 
   2651  1.1  christos       *secp = htab->sbss;
   2652  1.1  christos       *valp = sym->st_size;
   2653  1.1  christos     }
   2654  1.1  christos 
   2655  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2656  1.1  christos }
   2657  1.1  christos 
   2658  1.1  christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type.  */
   2660  1.1  christos 
   2661  1.1  christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
   2662  1.1  christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
   2663  1.1  christos   (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
   2664  1.1  christos    bfd_vma addend,
   2665  1.1  christos    elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   2666  1.1  christos {
   2667  1.1  christos   for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
   2668  1.1  christos     if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
   2669  1.1  christos       return linker_pointers;
   2670  1.3  christos 
   2671  1.3  christos   return NULL;
   2672  1.3  christos }
   2673  1.3  christos 
   2674  1.1  christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section.  */
   2675  1.1  christos 
   2676  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2677  1.1  christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
   2678  1.1  christos 				     elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   2679  1.1  christos 				     struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   2680  1.1  christos 				     const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   2681  1.1  christos {
   2682  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
   2683  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   2684  1.1  christos   unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2685  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type amt;
   2686  1.1  christos 
   2687  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   2688  1.1  christos 
   2689  1.1  christos   /* Is this a global symbol?  */
   2690  1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   2691  1.1  christos     {
   2692  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   2693  1.1  christos 
   2694  1.1  christos       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2695  1.1  christos       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   2696  1.1  christos       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
   2697  1.1  christos 					   rel->r_addend,
   2698  1.1  christos 					   lsect))
   2699  1.1  christos 	return TRUE;
   2700  1.1  christos 
   2701  1.1  christos       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
   2702  1.1  christos     }
   2703  1.1  christos   else
   2704  1.1  christos     {
   2705  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2706  1.1  christos 
   2707  1.1  christos       /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol.  */
   2708  1.1  christos       elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
   2709  1.1  christos 
   2710  1.1  christos       /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time.  */
   2711  1.1  christos       if (!ptr)
   2712  1.1  christos 	{
   2713  1.1  christos 	  unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
   2714  1.1  christos 
   2715  1.1  christos 	  amt = num_symbols;
   2716  1.1  christos 	  amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
   2717  1.1  christos 	  ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
   2718  1.1  christos 
   2719  1.1  christos 	  if (!ptr)
   2720  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2721  1.1  christos 
   2722  1.1  christos 	  elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
   2723  1.1  christos 	}
   2724  1.1  christos 
   2725  1.1  christos       /* Has this symbol already been allocated?  If so, our work is done.  */
   2726  1.1  christos       if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
   2727  1.1  christos 					   rel->r_addend,
   2728  1.1  christos 					   lsect))
   2729  1.1  christos 	return TRUE;
   2730  1.1  christos 
   2731  1.1  christos       ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
   2732  1.1  christos     }
   2733  1.1  christos 
   2734  1.1  christos   /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
   2735  1.1  christos      a new pointer record from internal memory.  */
   2736  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   2737  1.1  christos   amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
   2738  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2739  1.1  christos 
   2740  1.1  christos   if (!linker_section_ptr)
   2741  1.9  christos     return FALSE;
   2742  1.3  christos 
   2743  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
   2744  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
   2745  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
   2746  1.1  christos   *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
   2747  1.1  christos 
   2748  1.1  christos   if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
   2749  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   2750  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
   2751  1.1  christos   lsect->section->size += 4;
   2752  1.1  christos 
   2753  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   2754  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr,
   2755  1.1  christos 	   "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
   2756  1.1  christos 	   lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
   2757  1.1  christos 	   (long) lsect->section->size);
   2758  1.1  christos #endif
   2759  1.1  christos 
   2760  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2761  1.1  christos }
   2762  1.1  christos 
   2763  1.1  christos static struct plt_entry **
   2764  1.8  christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
   2765  1.1  christos 		       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
   2766  1.1  christos 		       unsigned long r_symndx,
   2767  1.1  christos 		       int tls_type)
   2768  1.1  christos {
   2769  1.1  christos   bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
   2770  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   2771  1.1  christos   unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
   2772  1.1  christos 
   2773  1.1  christos   if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2774  1.1  christos     {
   2775  1.1  christos       bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   2776  1.1  christos 
   2777  1.1  christos       size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
   2778  1.1  christos 	       + sizeof (*local_plt)
   2779  1.1  christos 	       + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
   2780  1.8  christos       local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
   2781  1.8  christos       if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
   2782  1.8  christos 	return NULL;
   2783  1.1  christos       elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
   2784  1.1  christos     }
   2785  1.1  christos 
   2786  1.1  christos   local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2787  1.1  christos   local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   2788  1.1  christos   local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
   2789  1.1  christos   if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
   2790  1.1  christos     local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
   2791  1.1  christos   return local_plt + r_symndx;
   2792  1.1  christos }
   2793  1.1  christos 
   2794  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2795  1.1  christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
   2796  1.1  christos 		 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2797  1.1  christos {
   2798  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2799  1.1  christos 
   2800  1.9  christos   if (addend < 32768)
   2801  1.1  christos     sec = NULL;
   2802  1.1  christos   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2803  1.1  christos     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2804  1.1  christos       break;
   2805  1.1  christos   if (ent == NULL)
   2806  1.1  christos     {
   2807  1.1  christos       size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
   2808  1.1  christos       ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
   2809  1.1  christos       if (ent == NULL)
   2810  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2811  1.1  christos       ent->next = *plist;
   2812  1.1  christos       ent->sec = sec;
   2813  1.1  christos       ent->addend = addend;
   2814  1.1  christos       ent->plt.refcount = 0;
   2815  1.1  christos       *plist = ent;
   2816  1.1  christos     }
   2817  1.1  christos   ent->plt.refcount += 1;
   2818  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   2819  1.1  christos }
   2820  1.1  christos 
   2821  1.1  christos static struct plt_entry *
   2822  1.1  christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
   2823  1.1  christos {
   2824  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   2825  1.1  christos 
   2826  1.1  christos   if (addend < 32768)
   2827  1.1  christos     sec = NULL;
   2828  1.1  christos   for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   2829  1.1  christos     if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
   2830  1.1  christos       break;
   2831  1.1  christos   return ent;
   2832  1.1  christos }
   2833  1.1  christos 
   2834  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2835  1.1  christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2836  1.1  christos {
   2837  1.1  christos   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   2838  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
   2839  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
   2840  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
   2841  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   2842  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
   2843  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
   2844  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
   2845  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
   2846  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
   2847  1.8  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
   2848  1.8  christos }
   2849  1.8  christos 
   2850  1.8  christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call.  */
   2851  1.8  christos 
   2852  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   2853  1.8  christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2854  1.1  christos {
   2855  1.1  christos   return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
   2856  1.1  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2857  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2858  1.7  christos 	  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
   2859  1.8  christos }
   2860  1.1  christos 
   2861  1.1  christos static void
   2862  1.1  christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
   2863  1.1  christos {
   2864  1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler
   2865  1.1  christos     /* xgettext:c-format */
   2866  1.1  christos     (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
   2867  1.1  christos      abfd,
   2868  1.1  christos      ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
   2869  1.1  christos   bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   2870  1.1  christos }
   2871  1.1  christos 
   2872  1.1  christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
   2873  1.1  christos    allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
   2874  1.1  christos    table.  */
   2875  1.1  christos 
   2876  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   2877  1.1  christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
   2878  1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   2879  1.1  christos 		      asection *sec,
   2880  1.1  christos 		      const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
   2881  1.1  christos {
   2882  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   2883  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   2884  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   2885  1.1  christos   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   2886  1.1  christos   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
   2887  1.8  christos   asection *got2, *sreloc;
   2888  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
   2889  1.1  christos 
   2890  1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   2891  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   2892  1.1  christos 
   2893  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   2894  1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
   2895  1.1  christos 		      sec, abfd);
   2896  1.1  christos #endif
   2897  1.1  christos 
   2898  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
   2899  1.1  christos 
   2900  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   2901  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   2902  1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   2903  1.1  christos 
   2904  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   2905  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink == NULL)
   2906  1.1  christos     {
   2907  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2908  1.1  christos 	htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2909  1.1  christos       if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2910  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   2911  1.1  christos     }
   2912  1.1  christos   tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   2913  1.1  christos 			      FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   2914  1.1  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   2915  1.1  christos   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
   2916  1.1  christos   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   2917  1.1  christos   sreloc = NULL;
   2918  1.1  christos 
   2919  1.6  christos   rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
   2920  1.8  christos   for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
   2921  1.8  christos     {
   2922  1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx;
   2923  1.1  christos       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   2924  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   2925  1.1  christos       int tls_type;
   2926  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **ifunc;
   2927  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **pltent;
   2928  1.1  christos       bfd_vma addend;
   2929  1.1  christos 
   2930  1.1  christos       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   2931  1.1  christos       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   2932  1.1  christos 	h = NULL;
   2933  1.1  christos       else
   2934  1.1  christos 	{
   2935  1.1  christos 	  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   2936  1.1  christos 	  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   2937  1.1  christos 		 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   2938  1.7  christos 	    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   2939  1.1  christos 	}
   2940  1.1  christos 
   2941  1.1  christos       /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
   2942  1.1  christos 	 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
   2943  1.1  christos 	 startup code.  */
   2944  1.1  christos       if (h != NULL
   2945  1.1  christos 	  && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
   2946  1.1  christos 	  && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
   2947  1.1  christos 	{
   2948  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   2949  1.1  christos 	    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   2950  1.6  christos 	  if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   2951  1.9  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2952  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
   2953  1.9  christos 	}
   2954  1.1  christos 
   2955  1.1  christos       tls_type = 0;
   2956  1.1  christos       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   2957  1.1  christos       ifunc = NULL;
   2958  1.1  christos       if (h == NULL && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   2959  1.1  christos 	{
   2960  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
   2961  1.1  christos 							  abfd, r_symndx);
   2962  1.8  christos 	  if (isym == NULL)
   2963  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   2964  1.1  christos 
   2965  1.1  christos 	  if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   2966  1.1  christos 	    {
   2967  1.1  christos 	      /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet.  */
   2968  1.1  christos 	      ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   2969  1.6  christos 					     NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
   2970  1.8  christos 	      if (ifunc == NULL)
   2971  1.8  christos 		return FALSE;
   2972  1.8  christos 
   2973  1.8  christos 	      /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
   2974  1.1  christos 		 In a non-pie executable even when there are
   2975  1.8  christos 		 no plt calls.  */
   2976  1.1  christos 	      if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   2977  1.8  christos 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   2978  1.8  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2979  1.8  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2980  1.8  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
   2981  1.8  christos 		{
   2982  1.8  christos 		  addend = 0;
   2983  1.8  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   2984  1.1  christos 		    ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   2985  1.1  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   2986  1.1  christos 		      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   2987  1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   2988  1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   2989  1.1  christos 			  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   2990  1.9  christos 		    addend = rel->r_addend;
   2991  1.1  christos 		  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
   2992  1.1  christos 		    return FALSE;
   2993  1.1  christos 		}
   2994  1.1  christos 	    }
   2995  1.1  christos 	}
   2996  1.1  christos 
   2997  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   2998  1.1  christos 	  && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   2999  1.1  christos 	  && h != NULL
   3000  1.1  christos 	  && h == tga)
   3001  1.1  christos 	{
   3002  1.1  christos 	  if (rel != relocs
   3003  1.9  christos 	      && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
   3004  1.1  christos 		  || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
   3005  1.1  christos 	    /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
   3006  1.1  christos 	       reloc.  */
   3007  1.1  christos 	    ;
   3008  1.1  christos 	  else
   3009  1.1  christos 	    /* Mark this section as having an old-style call.  */
   3010  1.1  christos 	    sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
   3011  1.1  christos 	}
   3012  1.8  christos 
   3013  1.8  christos       switch (r_type)
   3014  1.8  christos 	{
   3015  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   3016  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   3017  1.8  christos 	  /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
   3018  1.8  christos 	     its parameter symbol.  */
   3019  1.8  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3020  1.8  christos 	    ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
   3021  1.1  christos 	  else
   3022  1.1  christos 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3023  1.1  christos 					NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   3024  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3025  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3026  1.1  christos 
   3027  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   3028  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3029  1.1  christos 
   3030  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   3031  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   3032  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   3033  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   3034  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   3035  1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3036  1.1  christos 
   3037  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   3038  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   3039  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   3040  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   3041  1.8  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   3042  1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3043  1.1  christos 
   3044  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   3045  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   3046  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   3047  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   3048  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3049  1.1  christos 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3050  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   3051  1.1  christos 	  goto dogottls;
   3052  1.1  christos 
   3053  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   3054  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   3055  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   3056  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   3057  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   3058  1.1  christos 	dogottls:
   3059  1.1  christos 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3060  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3061  1.7  christos 
   3062  1.1  christos 	  /* GOT16 relocations */
   3063  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   3064  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   3065  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   3066  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   3067  1.1  christos 	  /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry.  */
   3068  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   3069  1.1  christos 	    {
   3070  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3071  1.1  christos 		htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3072  1.1  christos 	      if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
   3073  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3074  1.1  christos 	    }
   3075  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3076  1.1  christos 	    {
   3077  1.1  christos 	      h->got.refcount += 1;
   3078  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
   3079  1.1  christos 	    }
   3080  1.6  christos 	  else
   3081  1.1  christos 	    /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol.  */
   3082  1.1  christos 	    if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
   3083  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3084  1.1  christos 
   3085  1.1  christos 	  /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3086  1.1  christos 	     an ifunc.  */
   3087  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3088  1.1  christos 	    {
   3089  1.3  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3090  1.3  christos 		return FALSE;
   3091  1.3  christos 	    }
   3092  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3093  1.1  christos 
   3094  1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   3095  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   3096  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3097  1.1  christos 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   3098  1.1  christos 						    h, rel))
   3099  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3100  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3101  1.1  christos 	    {
   3102  1.9  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3103  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3104  1.1  christos 	    }
   3105  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3106  1.1  christos 
   3107  1.3  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   3108  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   3109  1.3  christos 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   3110  1.1  christos 	    {
   3111  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3112  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3113  1.1  christos 	    }
   3114  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3115  1.1  christos 	  if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   3116  1.1  christos 						    h, rel))
   3117  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3118  1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3119  1.3  christos 	    {
   3120  1.7  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3121  1.3  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3122  1.1  christos 	    }
   3123  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3124  1.1  christos 
   3125  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   3126  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3127  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3128  1.1  christos 
   3129  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   3130  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   3131  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   3132  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   3133  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   3134  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   3135  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3136  1.1  christos 	    {
   3137  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3138  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3139  1.1  christos 	    }
   3140  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3141  1.1  christos 
   3142  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   3143  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   3144  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   3145  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   3146  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   3147  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   3148  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   3149  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   3150  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   3151  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   3152  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3153  1.3  christos 
   3154  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   3155  1.1  christos 	  if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   3156  1.1  christos 	    {
   3157  1.1  christos 	      bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
   3158  1.1  christos 	      return FALSE;
   3159  1.1  christos 	    }
   3160  1.1  christos 	  htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
   3161  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3162  1.1  christos 	    {
   3163  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3164  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3165  1.1  christos 	    }
   3166  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3167  1.1  christos 
   3168  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   3169  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   3170  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   3171  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   3172  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3173  1.1  christos 	    {
   3174  1.1  christos 	      ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
   3175  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3176  1.1  christos 	    }
   3177  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3178  1.1  christos 
   3179  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   3180  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   3181  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   3182  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   3183  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   3184  1.8  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   3185  1.8  christos 	    h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
   3186  1.8  christos 	  break;
   3187  1.8  christos 
   3188  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   3189  1.8  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3190  1.8  christos 	    break;
   3191  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
   3192  1.1  christos 	  goto pltentry;
   3193  1.1  christos 
   3194  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   3195  1.1  christos 	  sec->has_pltcall = 1;
   3196  1.8  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3197  1.1  christos 
   3198  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   3199  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   3200  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   3201  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   3202  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   3203  1.8  christos 	pltentry:
   3204  1.8  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   3205  1.8  christos 	  fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
   3206  1.8  christos #endif
   3207  1.1  christos 	  /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry.  */
   3208  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3209  1.1  christos 	    {
   3210  1.8  christos 	      pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
   3211  1.8  christos 					      NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
   3212  1.1  christos 	      if (pltent == NULL)
   3213  1.8  christos 		return FALSE;
   3214  1.1  christos 	    }
   3215  1.8  christos 	  else
   3216  1.8  christos 	    {
   3217  1.8  christos 	      if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   3218  1.8  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
   3219  1.8  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3220  1.8  christos 	      pltent = &h->plt.plist;
   3221  1.8  christos 	    }
   3222  1.8  christos 	  addend = 0;
   3223  1.8  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3224  1.1  christos 	      && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   3225  1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   3226  1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   3227  1.1  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   3228  1.1  christos 	    addend = rel->r_addend;
   3229  1.1  christos 	  if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
   3230  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3231  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3232  1.1  christos 
   3233  1.1  christos 	  /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
   3234  1.1  christos 	     relocation if linking a shared object since they are
   3235  1.1  christos 	     section relative.  */
   3236  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   3237  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   3238  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   3239  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   3240  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   3241  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   3242  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   3243  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   3244  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_TOC16:
   3245  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3246  1.1  christos 
   3247  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   3248  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   3249  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   3250  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   3251  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   3252  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
   3253  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3254  1.1  christos 
   3255  1.1  christos 	  /* These are just markers.  */
   3256  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   3257  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   3258  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   3259  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_max:
   3260  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   3261  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   3262  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   3263  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
   3264  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3265  1.1  christos 
   3266  1.1  christos 	  /* These should only appear in dynamic objects.  */
   3267  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   3268  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   3269  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   3270  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   3271  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   3272  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3273  1.1  christos 
   3274  1.1  christos 	  /* These aren't handled yet.  We'll report an error later.  */
   3275  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   3276  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   3277  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   3278  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   3279  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   3280  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   3281  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3282  1.1  christos 
   3283  1.3  christos 	  /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library.  */
   3284  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   3285  1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3286  1.3  christos 	    {
   3287  1.3  christos 	      htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3288  1.3  christos 	      htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3289  1.1  christos 	    }
   3290  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   3291  1.1  christos 	    {
   3292  1.1  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3293  1.1  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3294  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3295  1.1  christos 	    }
   3296  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3297  1.1  christos 
   3298  1.1  christos 	  /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
   3299  1.1  christos 	     Reconstruct it for later use during GC.  */
   3300  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   3301  1.9  christos 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
   3302  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3303  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3304  1.1  christos 
   3305  1.9  christos 	  /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
   3306  1.9  christos 	     used.  Record for later use during GC.  */
   3307  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   3308  1.9  christos 	  if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
   3309  1.8  christos 	    return FALSE;
   3310  1.1  christos 	  break;
   3311  1.1  christos 
   3312  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   3313  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   3314  1.1  christos 	  sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
   3315  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   3316  1.1  christos 	  /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32.  */
   3317  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   3318  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   3319  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   3320  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   3321  1.1  christos 	    info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
   3322  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3323  1.1  christos 
   3324  1.1  christos 	  /* Nor these.  */
   3325  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   3326  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   3327  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3328  1.1  christos 
   3329  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   3330  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL
   3331  1.1  christos 	      && got2 != NULL
   3332  1.1  christos 	      && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
   3333  1.1  christos 	      && bfd_link_pic (info)
   3334  1.1  christos 	      && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3335  1.1  christos 	    {
   3336  1.1  christos 	      /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
   3337  1.1  christos 		 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
   3338  1.9  christos 		 reference to .got2.  If we detect one of these, then
   3339  1.1  christos 		 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
   3340  1.1  christos 		 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
   3341  1.1  christos 		 PLT call stubs.  */
   3342  1.1  christos 	      asection *s;
   3343  1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   3344  1.1  christos 
   3345  1.1  christos 	      isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
   3346  1.1  christos 					    abfd, r_symndx);
   3347  1.1  christos 	      if (isym == NULL)
   3348  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3349  1.1  christos 
   3350  1.1  christos 	      s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3351  1.1  christos 	      if (s == got2)
   3352  1.1  christos 		{
   3353  1.1  christos 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3354  1.1  christos 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3355  1.1  christos 		}
   3356  1.1  christos 	    }
   3357  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3358  1.1  christos 	    break;
   3359  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   3360  1.1  christos 
   3361  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   3362  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   3363  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   3364  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   3365  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   3366  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   3367  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   3368  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3369  1.1  christos 	    {
   3370  1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3371  1.5  christos 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3372  1.5  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3373  1.5  christos 		return FALSE;
   3374  1.5  christos 
   3375  1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a copy reloc too.  */
   3376  1.1  christos 	      h->non_got_ref = 1;
   3377  1.1  christos 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
   3378  1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   3379  1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
   3380  1.1  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
   3381  1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
   3382  1.1  christos 	    }
   3383  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   3384  1.1  christos 
   3385  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   3386  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   3387  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   3388  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   3389  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL)
   3390  1.1  christos 	    break;
   3391  1.1  christos 	  if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
   3392  1.1  christos 	    {
   3393  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3394  1.1  christos 		{
   3395  1.1  christos 		  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3396  1.1  christos 		  htab->old_bfd = abfd;
   3397  1.1  christos 		}
   3398  1.1  christos 	      break;
   3399  1.6  christos 	    }
   3400  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   3401  1.1  christos 
   3402  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   3403  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   3404  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   3405  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   3406  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   3407  1.1  christos 	    {
   3408  1.1  christos 	      /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
   3409  1.1  christos 		 a function defined in a dynamic object.  */
   3410  1.1  christos 	      h->needs_plt = 1;
   3411  1.1  christos 	      if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
   3412  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   3413  1.1  christos 	      break;
   3414  1.1  christos 	    }
   3415  1.1  christos 
   3416  1.1  christos 	dodyn:
   3417  1.1  christos 	  /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
   3418  1.1  christos 	     against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
   3419  1.1  christos 	     against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
   3420  1.1  christos 	     into the shared library.  However, if we are linking with
   3421  1.1  christos 	     -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
   3422  1.1  christos 	     global symbol which is defined in an object we are
   3423  1.1  christos 	     including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set).  At
   3424  1.1  christos 	     this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
   3425  1.1  christos 	     possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
   3426  1.1  christos 	     later (it is never cleared).  In case of a weak definition,
   3427  1.1  christos 	     DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
   3428  1.1  christos 	     a shared library.  We account for that possibility below by
   3429  1.1  christos 	     storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
   3430  1.1  christos 	     table entry.  A similar situation occurs when creating
   3431  1.6  christos 	     shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
   3432  1.1  christos 	     symbol local.
   3433  1.1  christos 
   3434  1.1  christos 	     If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
   3435  1.1  christos 	     may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
   3436  1.1  christos 	     dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
   3437  1.1  christos 	     symbol.  */
   3438  1.6  christos 	  if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
   3439  1.1  christos 	       && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
   3440  1.1  christos 		   || (h != NULL
   3441  1.1  christos 		       && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
   3442  1.1  christos 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
   3443  1.1  christos 			   || !h->def_regular))))
   3444  1.1  christos 	      || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   3445  1.1  christos 		  && !bfd_link_pic (info)
   3446  1.1  christos 		  && h != NULL
   3447  1.1  christos 		  && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
   3448  1.1  christos 		      || !h->def_regular)))
   3449  1.1  christos 	    {
   3450  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   3451  1.1  christos 	      fprintf (stderr,
   3452  1.1  christos 		       "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
   3453  1.1  christos 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   3454  1.1  christos 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   3455  1.1  christos 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   3456  1.1  christos #endif
   3457  1.1  christos 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   3458  1.1  christos 		{
   3459  1.1  christos 		  if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
   3460  1.1  christos 		    htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
   3461  1.1  christos 
   3462  1.1  christos 		  sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
   3463  1.1  christos 		    (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
   3464  1.1  christos 
   3465  1.1  christos 		  if (sreloc == NULL)
   3466  1.1  christos 		    return FALSE;
   3467  1.1  christos 		}
   3468  1.1  christos 
   3469  1.9  christos 	      /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
   3470  1.1  christos 		 relocations we need for this symbol.  */
   3471  1.1  christos 	      if (h != NULL)
   3472  1.1  christos 		{
   3473  1.1  christos 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   3474  1.1  christos 		  struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3475  1.1  christos 
   3476  1.1  christos 		  rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
   3477  1.1  christos 		  p = *rel_head;
   3478  1.1  christos 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
   3479  1.1  christos 		    {
   3480  1.1  christos 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3481  1.1  christos 		      if (p == NULL)
   3482  1.1  christos 			return FALSE;
   3483  1.1  christos 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3484  1.1  christos 		      *rel_head = p;
   3485  1.1  christos 		      p->sec = sec;
   3486  1.1  christos 		      p->count = 0;
   3487  1.1  christos 		      p->pc_count = 0;
   3488  1.1  christos 		    }
   3489  1.1  christos 		  p->count += 1;
   3490  1.1  christos 		  if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
   3491  1.1  christos 		    p->pc_count += 1;
   3492  1.1  christos 		}
   3493  1.1  christos 	      else
   3494  1.1  christos 		{
   3495  1.1  christos 		  /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
   3496  1.1  christos 		     We really need local syms available to do this
   3497  1.1  christos 		     easily.  Oh well.  */
   3498  1.9  christos 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   3499  1.1  christos 		  struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
   3500  1.1  christos 		  bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
   3501  1.1  christos 		  asection *s;
   3502  1.1  christos 		  void *vpp;
   3503  1.1  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   3504  1.1  christos 
   3505  1.1  christos 		  isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
   3506  1.1  christos 						abfd, r_symndx);
   3507  1.1  christos 		  if (isym == NULL)
   3508  1.1  christos 		    return FALSE;
   3509  1.1  christos 
   3510  1.1  christos 		  s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
   3511  1.1  christos 		  if (s == NULL)
   3512  1.1  christos 		    s = sec;
   3513  1.1  christos 
   3514  1.1  christos 		  vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
   3515  1.1  christos 		  rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
   3516  1.1  christos 		  is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
   3517  1.1  christos 		  p = *rel_head;
   3518  1.1  christos 		  if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3519  1.1  christos 		    p = p->next;
   3520  1.1  christos 		  if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
   3521  1.1  christos 		    {
   3522  1.1  christos 		      p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
   3523  1.1  christos 		      if (p == NULL)
   3524  1.1  christos 			return FALSE;
   3525  1.1  christos 		      p->next = *rel_head;
   3526  1.1  christos 		      *rel_head = p;
   3527  1.1  christos 		      p->sec = sec;
   3528  1.1  christos 		      p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
   3529  1.1  christos 		      p->count = 0;
   3530  1.1  christos 		    }
   3531  1.1  christos 		  p->count += 1;
   3532  1.1  christos 		}
   3533  1.1  christos 	    }
   3534  1.1  christos 
   3535  1.7  christos 	  break;
   3536  1.7  christos 	}
   3537  1.8  christos     }
   3538  1.7  christos 
   3539  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   3540  1.7  christos }
   3541  1.1  christos 
   3542  1.1  christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
   3544  1.9  christos    and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3545  1.9  christos bfd_boolean
   3546  1.9  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3547  1.9  christos {
   3548  1.9  christos   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3549  1.9  christos   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3550  1.9  christos   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3551  1.9  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   3552  1.9  christos   bfd_boolean warn_only;
   3553  1.9  christos 
   3554  1.9  christos   /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
   3555  1.1  christos      libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
   3556  1.1  christos      but actually support more than one variant.  For example, glibc
   3557  1.1  christos      typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
   3558  1.1  christos      but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
   3559  1.1  christos      The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
   3560  1.1  christos      object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
   3561  1.7  christos      layer objects and only from there call into the shared library.  */
   3562  1.1  christos   warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
   3563  1.1  christos 
   3564  1.7  christos   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3565  1.7  christos   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3566  1.8  christos 
   3567  1.7  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3568  1.7  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
   3569  1.1  christos 
   3570  1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3571  1.7  christos     {
   3572  1.9  christos       int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
   3573  1.9  christos       int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
   3574  1.9  christos       static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
   3575  1.9  christos 
   3576  1.9  christos       if (in_fp == 0)
   3577  1.9  christos 	;
   3578  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3579  1.7  christos 	{
   3580  1.8  christos 	  if (!warn_only)
   3581  1.8  christos 	    {
   3582  1.8  christos 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3583  1.8  christos 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3584  1.8  christos 	      last_fp = ibfd;
   3585  1.9  christos 	    }
   3586  1.8  christos 	}
   3587  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
   3588  1.8  christos 	{
   3589  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3590  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3591  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3592  1.8  christos 	     last_fp, ibfd);
   3593  1.9  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3594  1.8  christos 	}
   3595  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
   3596  1.8  christos 	{
   3597  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3598  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3599  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
   3600  1.8  christos 	     ibfd, last_fp);
   3601  1.9  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3602  1.8  christos 	}
   3603  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
   3604  1.8  christos 	{
   3605  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3606  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3607  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3608  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
   3609  1.9  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3610  1.8  christos 	}
   3611  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
   3612  1.7  christos 	{
   3613  1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3614  1.7  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3615  1.7  christos 	    (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
   3616  1.7  christos 	       "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
   3617  1.7  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3618  1.9  christos 	}
   3619  1.9  christos 
   3620  1.9  christos       in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
   3621  1.9  christos       out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
   3622  1.9  christos       if (in_fp == 0)
   3623  1.9  christos 	;
   3624  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 0)
   3625  1.7  christos 	{
   3626  1.8  christos 	  if (!warn_only)
   3627  1.8  christos 	    {
   3628  1.8  christos 	      out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3629  1.8  christos 	      out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
   3630  1.8  christos 	      last_ld = ibfd;
   3631  1.9  christos 	    }
   3632  1.8  christos 	}
   3633  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
   3634  1.8  christos 	{
   3635  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3636  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3637  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3638  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3639  1.9  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3640  1.8  christos 	}
   3641  1.7  christos       else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
   3642  1.8  christos 	{
   3643  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3644  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3645  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
   3646  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3647  1.9  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3648  1.8  christos 	}
   3649  1.7  christos       else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
   3650  1.8  christos 	{
   3651  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3652  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3653  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3654  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
   3655  1.9  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3656  1.8  christos 	}
   3657  1.8  christos       else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
   3658  1.8  christos 	{
   3659  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3660  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3661  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
   3662  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
   3663  1.1  christos 	  ret = warn_only;
   3664  1.8  christos 	}
   3665  1.7  christos     }
   3666  1.7  christos 
   3667  1.7  christos   if (!ret)
   3668  1.7  christos     {
   3669  1.7  christos       out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3670  1.7  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3671  1.7  christos     }
   3672  1.7  christos   return ret;
   3673  1.7  christos }
   3674  1.7  christos 
   3675  1.8  christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD.  Warn if
   3676  1.7  christos    there are conflicting attributes.  */
   3677  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   3678  1.8  christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3679  1.7  christos {
   3680  1.7  christos   bfd *obfd;
   3681  1.7  christos   obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
   3682  1.7  christos   obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
   3683  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean ret;
   3684  1.1  christos 
   3685  1.1  christos   if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3686  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   3687  1.1  christos 
   3688  1.8  christos   obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3689  1.1  christos   in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3690  1.1  christos   out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
   3691  1.7  christos 
   3692  1.7  christos   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
   3693  1.8  christos      merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3694  1.1  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3695  1.7  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
   3696  1.7  christos   ret = TRUE;
   3697  1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3698  1.1  christos     {
   3699  1.8  christos       int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
   3700  1.7  christos       int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
   3701  1.8  christos       static bfd *last_vec;
   3702  1.1  christos 
   3703  1.1  christos       if (in_vec == 0)
   3704  1.1  christos 	;
   3705  1.1  christos       else if (out_vec == 0)
   3706  1.1  christos 	{
   3707  1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3708  1.7  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3709  1.1  christos 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3710  1.7  christos 	}
   3711  1.7  christos       /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
   3712  1.8  christos 	 without a warning.  If GCC marked files with their stack
   3713  1.7  christos 	 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
   3714  1.8  christos 	 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
   3715  1.7  christos 	 case too.  */
   3716  1.7  christos       else if (in_vec == 1)
   3717  1.8  christos 	;
   3718  1.8  christos       else if (out_vec == 1)
   3719  1.8  christos 	{
   3720  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3721  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_vec;
   3722  1.8  christos 	  last_vec = ibfd;
   3723  1.8  christos 	}
   3724  1.8  christos       else if (out_vec < in_vec)
   3725  1.7  christos 	{
   3726  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3727  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3728  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3729  1.8  christos 	     last_vec, ibfd);
   3730  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3731  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3732  1.8  christos 	}
   3733  1.8  christos       else if (out_vec > in_vec)
   3734  1.1  christos 	{
   3735  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3736  1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3737  1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
   3738  1.1  christos 	     ibfd, last_vec);
   3739  1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3740  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3741  1.1  christos 	}
   3742  1.7  christos     }
   3743  1.7  christos 
   3744  1.8  christos   /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
   3745  1.7  christos      and merge non-conflicting ones.  */
   3746  1.7  christos   in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3747  1.1  christos   out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
   3748  1.7  christos   if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
   3749  1.7  christos     {
   3750  1.8  christos       int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
   3751  1.7  christos       int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
   3752  1.8  christos       static bfd *last_struct;
   3753  1.7  christos 
   3754  1.7  christos       if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
   3755  1.8  christos        ;
   3756  1.8  christos       else if (out_struct == 0)
   3757  1.8  christos 	{
   3758  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
   3759  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->i = in_struct;
   3760  1.8  christos 	  last_struct = ibfd;
   3761  1.8  christos 	}
   3762  1.8  christos       else if (out_struct < in_struct)
   3763  1.7  christos 	{
   3764  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3765  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3766  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3767  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
   3768  1.8  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3769  1.8  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3770  1.8  christos 	}
   3771  1.8  christos       else if (out_struct > in_struct)
   3772  1.8  christos 	{
   3773  1.8  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3774  1.8  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3775  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
   3776  1.8  christos 	       "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
   3777  1.1  christos 	  out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
   3778  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   3779  1.1  christos 	}
   3780  1.8  christos     }
   3781  1.1  christos   if (!ret)
   3782  1.1  christos     {
   3783  1.1  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3784  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   3785  1.1  christos     }
   3786  1.1  christos 
   3787  1.7  christos   /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones.  */
   3788  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
   3789  1.7  christos }
   3790  1.1  christos 
   3791  1.1  christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
   3792  1.1  christos    object file when linking.  */
   3793  1.1  christos 
   3794  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   3795  1.1  christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3796  1.1  christos {
   3797  1.1  christos   bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
   3798  1.7  christos   flagword old_flags;
   3799  1.1  christos   flagword new_flags;
   3800  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean error;
   3801  1.7  christos 
   3802  1.1  christos   if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
   3803  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   3804  1.9  christos 
   3805  1.9  christos   /* Check if we have the same endianness.  */
   3806  1.9  christos   if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
   3807  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   3808  1.1  christos 
   3809  1.1  christos   if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
   3810  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   3811  1.1  christos 
   3812  1.1  christos   if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
   3813  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   3814  1.1  christos 
   3815  1.1  christos   new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
   3816  1.1  christos   old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
   3817  1.1  christos   if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
   3818  1.1  christos     {
   3819  1.1  christos       /* First call, no flags set.  */
   3820  1.1  christos       elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
   3821  1.1  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
   3822  1.1  christos     }
   3823  1.1  christos 
   3824  1.1  christos   /* Compatible flags are ok.  */
   3825  1.1  christos   else if (new_flags == old_flags)
   3826  1.1  christos     ;
   3827  1.1  christos 
   3828  1.1  christos   /* Incompatible flags.  */
   3829  1.1  christos   else
   3830  1.7  christos     {
   3831  1.8  christos       /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch.  Allow -mrelocatable-lib
   3832  1.1  christos 	 to be linked with either.  */
   3833  1.1  christos       error = FALSE;
   3834  1.1  christos       if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
   3835  1.1  christos 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
   3836  1.1  christos 	{
   3837  1.1  christos 	  error = TRUE;
   3838  1.7  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3839  1.8  christos 	    (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
   3840  1.1  christos 	       "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
   3841  1.1  christos 	}
   3842  1.1  christos       else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
   3843  1.1  christos 	       && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
   3844  1.1  christos 	{
   3845  1.1  christos 	  error = TRUE;
   3846  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3847  1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
   3848  1.1  christos 	       "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
   3849  1.1  christos 	}
   3850  1.1  christos 
   3851  1.1  christos       /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are.  */
   3852  1.1  christos       if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
   3853  1.1  christos 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
   3854  1.1  christos 
   3855  1.1  christos       /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
   3856  1.1  christos 	 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib.  */
   3857  1.1  christos       if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
   3858  1.1  christos 	  && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
   3859  1.1  christos 	  && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
   3860  1.1  christos 	elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
   3861  1.1  christos 
   3862  1.1  christos       /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
   3863  1.1  christos 	 any module uses it.  */
   3864  1.1  christos       elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
   3865  1.7  christos 
   3866  1.7  christos       new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3867  1.8  christos       old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
   3868  1.8  christos 
   3869  1.8  christos       /* Warn about any other mismatches.  */
   3870  1.1  christos       if (new_flags != old_flags)
   3871  1.1  christos 	{
   3872  1.1  christos 	  error = TRUE;
   3873  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler
   3874  1.1  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   3875  1.1  christos 	    (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
   3876  1.1  christos 	       "than previous modules (%#x)"),
   3877  1.1  christos 	     ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
   3878  1.1  christos 	}
   3879  1.1  christos 
   3880  1.1  christos       if (error)
   3881  1.1  christos 	{
   3882  1.1  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   3883  1.7  christos 	  return FALSE;
   3884  1.7  christos 	}
   3885  1.7  christos     }
   3886  1.7  christos 
   3887  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   3888  1.7  christos }
   3889  1.7  christos 
   3890  1.1  christos static void
   3891  1.8  christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
   3892  1.1  christos 		     asection *input_section,
   3893  1.7  christos 		     unsigned long offset,
   3894  1.8  christos 		     bfd_byte *loc,
   3895  1.7  christos 		     bfd_vma value,
   3896  1.7  christos 		     split16_format_type split16_format,
   3897  1.7  christos 		     bfd_boolean fixup)
   3898  1.7  christos {
   3899  1.7  christos   unsigned int insn, opcode;
   3900  1.7  christos 
   3901  1.7  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
   3902  1.7  christos   opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
   3903  1.7  christos   if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
   3904  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
   3905  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
   3906  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
   3907  1.7  christos       || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
   3908  1.8  christos     {
   3909  1.7  christos       if (split16_format != split16a_type)
   3910  1.7  christos 	{
   3911  1.7  christos 	  if (fixup)
   3912  1.7  christos 	    split16_format = split16a_type;
   3913  1.7  christos 	  else
   3914  1.7  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3915  1.7  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3916  1.7  christos 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3917  1.7  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3918  1.7  christos 	}
   3919  1.7  christos     }
   3920  1.7  christos   else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
   3921  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
   3922  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
   3923  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
   3924  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
   3925  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
   3926  1.7  christos 	   || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
   3927  1.8  christos     {
   3928  1.7  christos       if (split16_format != split16d_type)
   3929  1.7  christos 	{
   3930  1.7  christos 	  if (fixup)
   3931  1.8  christos 	    split16_format = split16d_type;
   3932  1.8  christos 	  else
   3933  1.8  christos 	    _bfd_error_handler
   3934  1.8  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   3935  1.8  christos 	      (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
   3936  1.8  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
   3937  1.8  christos 	}
   3938  1.8  christos     }
   3939  1.8  christos   if (split16_format == split16a_type)
   3940  1.8  christos     {
   3941  1.8  christos       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
   3942  1.8  christos       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3943  1.8  christos       if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
   3944  1.8  christos 	{
   3945  1.8  christos 	  /* Hack for e_li.  Extend sign.  */
   3946  1.8  christos 	  insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
   3947  1.3  christos 	  insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3948  1.7  christos 	}
   3949  1.1  christos     }
   3950  1.8  christos   else
   3951  1.8  christos     {
   3952  1.8  christos       insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
   3953  1.8  christos       insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
   3954  1.8  christos     }
   3955  1.8  christos   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3956  1.8  christos   bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
   3957  1.8  christos }
   3958  1.8  christos 
   3959  1.8  christos static void
   3960  1.8  christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
   3961  1.8  christos {
   3962  1.8  christos   unsigned int insn;
   3963  1.8  christos 
   3964  1.8  christos   insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   3965  1.8  christos   /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   3966  1.8  christos   /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   3967  1.1  christos   insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   3968  1.1  christos   /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   3969  1.1  christos   insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
   3970  1.1  christos   /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   3971  1.1  christos   insn |= value & 0x7ff;
   3972  1.3  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
   3973  1.1  christos }
   3974  1.1  christos 
   3975  1.1  christos 
   3976  1.1  christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
   3978  1.1  christos    Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT.  */
   3979  1.1  christos int
   3980  1.1  christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   3981  1.1  christos 			   struct bfd_link_info *info)
   3982  1.1  christos {
   3983  1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   3984  1.1  christos   flagword flags;
   3985  1.6  christos 
   3986  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   3987  1.1  christos 
   3988  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   3989  1.1  christos     {
   3990  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   3991  1.1  christos 
   3992  1.1  christos       if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
   3993  1.8  christos 	htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   3994  1.1  christos       else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   3995  1.1  christos 	       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   3996  1.1  christos 	       && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
   3997  1.1  christos 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
   3998  1.1  christos 	       && (h->type == STT_FUNC
   3999  1.1  christos 		   || h->needs_plt)
   4000  1.1  christos 	       && h->ref_regular
   4001  1.1  christos 	       && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   4002  1.1  christos 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   4003  1.1  christos 	{
   4004  1.3  christos 	  /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
   4005  1.1  christos 	     secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
   4006  1.1  christos 	     function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
   4007  1.1  christos 	     r30 to be set up.  */
   4008  1.1  christos 	  htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4009  1.1  christos 	}
   4010  1.1  christos       else
   4011  1.1  christos 	{
   4012  1.3  christos 	  bfd *ibfd;
   4013  1.1  christos 	  enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
   4014  1.1  christos 
   4015  1.1  christos 	  /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
   4016  1.1  christos 	     Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
   4017  1.1  christos 	     without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
   4018  1.1  christos 	     --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs.  */
   4019  1.1  christos 	  if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
   4020  1.1  christos 	    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4021  1.1  christos 	  for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4022  1.1  christos 	    if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4023  1.1  christos 	      {
   4024  1.1  christos 		if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
   4025  1.1  christos 		  plt_type = PLT_NEW;
   4026  1.1  christos 		else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
   4027  1.3  christos 		  {
   4028  1.1  christos 		    plt_type = PLT_OLD;
   4029  1.1  christos 		    htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
   4030  1.8  christos 		    break;
   4031  1.1  christos 		  }
   4032  1.8  christos 	      }
   4033  1.1  christos 	  htab->plt_type = plt_type;
   4034  1.1  christos 	}
   4035  1.1  christos     }
   4036  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
   4037  1.1  christos     {
   4038  1.1  christos       if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
   4039  1.1  christos 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
   4040  1.1  christos       else
   4041  1.1  christos 	_bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
   4042  1.1  christos     }
   4043  1.7  christos 
   4044  1.9  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
   4045  1.1  christos 
   4046  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   4047  1.1  christos     {
   4048  1.7  christos       flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
   4049  1.9  christos 	       | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
   4050  1.1  christos 
   4051  1.1  christos       /* The new PLT is a loaded section.  */
   4052  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4053  1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
   4054  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4055  1.1  christos 
   4056  1.9  christos       /* The new GOT is not executable.  */
   4057  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   4058  1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
   4059  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4060  1.1  christos     }
   4061  1.1  christos   else
   4062  1.1  christos     {
   4063  1.1  christos       /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment.  */
   4064  1.1  christos       if (htab->glink != NULL
   4065  1.1  christos 	  && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
   4066  1.1  christos 	return -1;
   4067  1.1  christos     }
   4068  1.1  christos   return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
   4069  1.1  christos }
   4070  1.1  christos 
   4071  1.1  christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
   4073  1.1  christos    relocation.  */
   4074  1.1  christos 
   4075  1.1  christos static asection *
   4076  1.1  christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
   4077  1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4078  1.1  christos 		      Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4079  1.1  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4080  1.1  christos 		      Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   4081  1.1  christos {
   4082  1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   4083  1.1  christos     switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   4084  1.8  christos       {
   4085  1.8  christos       case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   4086  1.8  christos       case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   4087  1.8  christos 	return NULL;
   4088  1.8  christos       }
   4089  1.8  christos 
   4090  1.8  christos   return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
   4091  1.1  christos }
   4092  1.8  christos 
   4093  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   4094  1.8  christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
   4095  1.8  christos 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
   4096  1.8  christos 	   asection **symsecp,
   4097  1.8  christos 	   unsigned char **tls_maskp,
   4098  1.1  christos 	   Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
   4099  1.8  christos 	   unsigned long r_symndx,
   4100  1.8  christos 	   bfd *ibfd)
   4101  1.8  christos {
   4102  1.8  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4103  1.1  christos 
   4104  1.8  christos   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4105  1.8  christos     {
   4106  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4107  1.8  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4108  1.8  christos 
   4109  1.1  christos       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4110  1.8  christos       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4111  1.8  christos 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4112  1.8  christos 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4113  1.8  christos 
   4114  1.8  christos       if (hp != NULL)
   4115  1.8  christos 	*hp = h;
   4116  1.8  christos 
   4117  1.8  christos       if (symp != NULL)
   4118  1.1  christos 	*symp = NULL;
   4119  1.8  christos 
   4120  1.8  christos       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4121  1.8  christos 	{
   4122  1.8  christos 	  asection *symsec = NULL;
   4123  1.1  christos 	  if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4124  1.8  christos 	      || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   4125  1.8  christos 	    symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
   4126  1.1  christos 	  *symsecp = symsec;
   4127  1.8  christos 	}
   4128  1.1  christos 
   4129  1.8  christos       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4130  1.8  christos 	*tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4131  1.8  christos     }
   4132  1.8  christos   else
   4133  1.8  christos     {
   4134  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4135  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
   4136  1.8  christos 
   4137  1.8  christos       if (locsyms == NULL)
   4138  1.8  christos 	{
   4139  1.1  christos 	  locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
   4140  1.8  christos 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4141  1.8  christos 	    locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
   4142  1.8  christos 					    symtab_hdr->sh_info,
   4143  1.8  christos 					    0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
   4144  1.8  christos 	  if (locsyms == NULL)
   4145  1.8  christos 	    return FALSE;
   4146  1.8  christos 	  *locsymsp = locsyms;
   4147  1.8  christos 	}
   4148  1.1  christos       sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
   4149  1.8  christos 
   4150  1.8  christos       if (hp != NULL)
   4151  1.8  christos 	*hp = NULL;
   4152  1.8  christos 
   4153  1.1  christos       if (symp != NULL)
   4154  1.8  christos 	*symp = sym;
   4155  1.8  christos 
   4156  1.8  christos       if (symsecp != NULL)
   4157  1.1  christos 	*symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
   4158  1.8  christos 
   4159  1.8  christos       if (tls_maskp != NULL)
   4160  1.8  christos 	{
   4161  1.8  christos 	  bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   4162  1.8  christos 	  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4163  1.1  christos 
   4164  1.8  christos 	  tls_mask = NULL;
   4165  1.1  christos 	  local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4166  1.8  christos 	  if (local_got != NULL)
   4167  1.8  christos 	    {
   4168  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4169  1.8  christos 		(local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4170  1.8  christos 	      unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4171  1.8  christos 		(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4172  1.8  christos 	      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4173  1.8  christos 	    }
   4174  1.8  christos 	  *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
   4175  1.8  christos 	}
   4176  1.8  christos     }
   4177  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   4178  1.8  christos }
   4179  1.8  christos 
   4180  1.8  christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
   4182  1.8  christos    defined functions can be converted to direct calls.  */
   4183  1.8  christos 
   4184  1.8  christos bfd_boolean
   4185  1.8  christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4186  1.8  christos {
   4187  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4188  1.8  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   4189  1.8  christos   asection *sec;
   4190  1.8  christos   bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
   4191  1.8  christos 
   4192  1.8  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4193  1.8  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   4194  1.8  christos     return FALSE;
   4195  1.8  christos 
   4196  1.8  christos   /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc.  The limit is
   4197  1.8  christos      reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
   4198  1.8  christos      between the call and its destination.  */
   4199  1.1  christos   limit = 0x1e00000;
   4200  1.8  christos   low_vma = -1;
   4201  1.8  christos   high_vma = 0;
   4202  1.8  christos   for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4203  1.8  christos     if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
   4204  1.8  christos       {
   4205  1.8  christos 	if (low_vma > sec->vma)
   4206  1.8  christos 	  low_vma = sec->vma;
   4207  1.8  christos 	if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
   4208  1.8  christos 	  high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
   4209  1.8  christos       }
   4210  1.8  christos 
   4211  1.8  christos   /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
   4212  1.8  christos      convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
   4213  1.8  christos      is local.  */
   4214  1.8  christos   if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
   4215  1.8  christos     {
   4216  1.8  christos       htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
   4217  1.8  christos       return TRUE;
   4218  1.8  christos     }
   4219  1.8  christos 
   4220  1.8  christos   /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
   4221  1.8  christos      call won't reach.  Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
   4222  1.8  christos      the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
   4223  1.8  christos      this will be better than creating trampolines.  Note that this
   4224  1.8  christos      will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
   4225  1.8  christos      particular symbol, not just those that won't reach.  The
   4226  1.8  christos      difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
   4227  1.8  christos      linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
   4228  1.8  christos      particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
   4229  1.1  christos      call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
   4230  1.8  christos      the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
   4231  1.8  christos      together except their symbol.  */
   4232  1.1  christos 
   4233  1.8  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4234  1.8  christos     {
   4235  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   4236  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
   4237  1.8  christos 
   4238  1.1  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   4239  1.8  christos 	continue;
   4240  1.8  christos 
   4241  1.8  christos       local_syms = NULL;
   4242  1.8  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4243  1.8  christos 
   4244  1.1  christos       for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4245  1.8  christos 	if (sec->has_pltcall
   4246  1.8  christos 	    && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4247  1.8  christos 	  {
   4248  1.8  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4249  1.8  christos 
   4250  1.8  christos 	    /* Read the relocations.  */
   4251  1.8  christos 	    relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4252  1.8  christos 						  info->keep_memory);
   4253  1.8  christos 	    if (relstart == NULL)
   4254  1.8  christos 	      return FALSE;
   4255  1.8  christos 
   4256  1.8  christos 	    relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4257  1.8  christos 	    for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
   4258  1.8  christos 	      {
   4259  1.8  christos 		enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4260  1.8  christos 		unsigned long r_symndx;
   4261  1.8  christos 		asection *sym_sec;
   4262  1.8  christos 		struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4263  1.8  christos 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   4264  1.8  christos 		unsigned char *tls_maskp;
   4265  1.9  christos 
   4266  1.8  christos 		r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4267  1.8  christos 		if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
   4268  1.8  christos 		  continue;
   4269  1.1  christos 
   4270  1.8  christos 		r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4271  1.8  christos 		if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
   4272  1.8  christos 				r_symndx, ibfd))
   4273  1.8  christos 		  {
   4274  1.8  christos 		    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4275  1.8  christos 		      free (relstart);
   4276  1.8  christos 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4277  1.8  christos 		      free (local_syms);
   4278  1.8  christos 		    return FALSE;
   4279  1.8  christos 		  }
   4280  1.8  christos 
   4281  1.8  christos 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   4282  1.8  christos 		  {
   4283  1.8  christos 		    bfd_vma from, to;
   4284  1.8  christos 		    if (h != NULL)
   4285  1.8  christos 		      to = h->root.u.def.value;
   4286  1.8  christos 		    else
   4287  1.8  christos 		      to = sym->st_value;
   4288  1.8  christos 		    to += (rel->r_addend
   4289  1.8  christos 			   + sym_sec->output_offset
   4290  1.1  christos 			   + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
   4291  1.8  christos 		    from = (rel->r_offset
   4292  1.8  christos 			    + sec->output_offset
   4293  1.8  christos 			    + sec->output_section->vma);
   4294  1.8  christos 		    if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
   4295  1.8  christos 		      *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
   4296  1.8  christos 		  }
   4297  1.8  christos 	      }
   4298  1.1  christos 	    if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4299  1.1  christos 	      free (relstart);
   4300  1.8  christos 	  }
   4301  1.1  christos 
   4302  1.1  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   4303  1.8  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   4304  1.1  christos 	{
   4305  1.1  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   4306  1.1  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   4307  1.1  christos 	  else
   4308  1.3  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   4309  1.1  christos 	}
   4310  1.1  christos     }
   4311  1.1  christos 
   4312  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   4313  1.1  christos }
   4314  1.1  christos 
   4315  1.5  christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
   4316  1.5  christos    generic ELF tls_setup function.  */
   4317  1.5  christos 
   4318  1.3  christos asection *
   4319  1.1  christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4320  1.1  christos {
   4321  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4322  1.1  christos 
   4323  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4324  1.1  christos   htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
   4325  1.1  christos 					     FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   4326  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   4327  1.1  christos     htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
   4328  1.1  christos 
   4329  1.1  christos   if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   4330  1.1  christos     {
   4331  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
   4332  1.1  christos       opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
   4333  1.1  christos 				  FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
   4334  1.1  christos       if (opt != NULL
   4335  1.1  christos 	  && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   4336  1.1  christos 	      || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   4337  1.8  christos 	{
   4338  1.1  christos 	  /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
   4339  1.1  christos 	     signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
   4340  1.1  christos 	     be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
   4341  1.1  christos 	     make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt.  */
   4342  1.1  christos 	  tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
   4343  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   4344  1.1  christos 	      && tga != NULL
   4345  1.1  christos 	      && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
   4346  1.1  christos 		  || tga->needs_plt)
   4347  1.1  christos 	      && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
   4348  1.7  christos 		   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
   4349  1.1  christos 	    {
   4350  1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4351  1.1  christos 	      for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4352  1.1  christos 		if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4353  1.1  christos 		  break;
   4354  1.1  christos 	      if (ent != NULL)
   4355  1.1  christos 		{
   4356  1.1  christos 		  tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
   4357  1.1  christos 		  tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
   4358  1.1  christos 		  ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
   4359  1.1  christos 		  opt->mark = 1;
   4360  1.1  christos 		  if (opt->dynindx != -1)
   4361  1.1  christos 		    {
   4362  1.1  christos 		      /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations.  */
   4363  1.3  christos 		      opt->dynindx = -1;
   4364  1.1  christos 		      _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
   4365  1.1  christos 					      opt->dynstr_index);
   4366  1.7  christos 		      if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
   4367  1.7  christos 			return FALSE;
   4368  1.1  christos 		    }
   4369  1.7  christos 		  htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
   4370  1.7  christos 		}
   4371  1.1  christos 	    }
   4372  1.1  christos 	}
   4373  1.1  christos       else
   4374  1.1  christos 	htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
   4375  1.1  christos     }
   4376  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   4377  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   4378  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
   4379  1.1  christos     {
   4380  1.1  christos       elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
   4381  1.1  christos       elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
   4382  1.1  christos     }
   4383  1.1  christos 
   4384  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
   4385  1.1  christos }
   4386  1.1  christos 
   4387  1.1  christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
   4388  1.1  christos    HASH.  */
   4389  1.1  christos 
   4390  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4391  1.1  christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
   4392  1.1  christos 			 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
   4393  1.1  christos 			 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
   4394  1.1  christos {
   4395  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4396  1.1  christos   enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4397  1.1  christos   unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4398  1.1  christos 
   4399  1.1  christos   if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4400  1.1  christos     {
   4401  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4402  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   4403  1.1  christos 
   4404  1.1  christos       h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4405  1.1  christos       while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4406  1.1  christos 	     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4407  1.1  christos 	h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4408  1.1  christos       if (h == hash)
   4409  1.1  christos 	return TRUE;
   4410  1.1  christos     }
   4411  1.1  christos   return FALSE;
   4412  1.1  christos }
   4413  1.1  christos 
   4414  1.1  christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
   4415  1.6  christos    opportunities.  */
   4416  1.1  christos 
   4417  1.1  christos bfd_boolean
   4418  1.1  christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
   4419  1.1  christos 		      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4420  1.1  christos {
   4421  1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   4422  1.9  christos   asection *sec;
   4423  1.9  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4424  1.1  christos   int pass;
   4425  1.1  christos 
   4426  1.1  christos   if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
   4427  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   4428  1.1  christos 
   4429  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4430  1.1  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   4431  1.3  christos     return FALSE;
   4432  1.1  christos 
   4433  1.1  christos   htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
   4434  1.1  christos 
   4435  1.1  christos   /* Make two passes through the relocs.  First time check that tls
   4436  1.1  christos      relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
   4437  1.1  christos      followed by such a call.  If they are not, don't do any tls
   4438  1.1  christos      optimization.  On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
   4439  1.1  christos      notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
   4440  1.1  christos      adjust got and plt refcounts.  */
   4441  1.1  christos   for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
   4442  1.1  christos     for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   4443  1.1  christos       {
   4444  1.1  christos 	Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   4445  1.1  christos 	asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
   4446  1.1  christos 
   4447  1.1  christos 	for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
   4448  1.1  christos 	  if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
   4449  1.1  christos 	    {
   4450  1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
   4451  1.1  christos 	      int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4452  1.1  christos 
   4453  1.1  christos 	      /* Read the relocations.  */
   4454  1.8  christos 	      relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
   4455  1.8  christos 						    info->keep_memory);
   4456  1.1  christos 	      if (relstart == NULL)
   4457  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   4458  1.1  christos 
   4459  1.1  christos 	      relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
   4460  1.1  christos 	      for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
   4461  1.1  christos 		{
   4462  1.1  christos 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   4463  1.1  christos 		  unsigned long r_symndx;
   4464  1.1  christos 		  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
   4465  1.1  christos 		  unsigned char *tls_mask;
   4466  1.1  christos 		  unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
   4467  1.1  christos 		  bfd_boolean is_local;
   4468  1.1  christos 		  bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
   4469  1.1  christos 
   4470  1.1  christos 		  r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   4471  1.9  christos 		  if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4472  1.1  christos 		    {
   4473  1.1  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4474  1.1  christos 
   4475  1.1  christos 		      sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4476  1.1  christos 		      h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4477  1.1  christos 		      while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4478  1.1  christos 			     || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4479  1.1  christos 			h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4480  1.9  christos 		    }
   4481  1.1  christos 
   4482  1.1  christos 		  is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
   4483  1.1  christos 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   4484  1.1  christos 		  /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4485  1.1  christos 		     without marker relocs, then check that each
   4486  1.1  christos 		     __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
   4487  1.1  christos 		     that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
   4488  1.1  christos 		     setup insn.  If we don't find matching arg setup
   4489  1.1  christos 		     relocs, don't do any tls optimization.  */
   4490  1.1  christos 		  if (pass == 0
   4491  1.1  christos 		      && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
   4492  1.1  christos 		      && h != NULL
   4493  1.1  christos 		      && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   4494  1.1  christos 		      && !expecting_tls_get_addr
   4495  1.1  christos 		      && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
   4496  1.1  christos 		    {
   4497  1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
   4498  1.1  christos 					      "TLS optimization disabled\n",
   4499  1.1  christos 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4500  1.7  christos 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4501  1.1  christos 			free (relstart);
   4502  1.1  christos 		      return TRUE;
   4503  1.1  christos 		    }
   4504  1.1  christos 
   4505  1.1  christos 		  expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
   4506  1.1  christos 		  switch (r_type)
   4507  1.1  christos 		    {
   4508  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   4509  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   4510  1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4511  1.1  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4512  1.1  christos 
   4513  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   4514  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   4515  1.1  christos 		      /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
   4516  1.1  christos 			 defined in a shared lib.  Leave them alone if
   4517  1.1  christos 			 that turns out to be the case.  */
   4518  1.7  christos 		      if (!is_local)
   4519  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4520  1.1  christos 
   4521  1.1  christos 		      /* LD -> LE */
   4522  1.1  christos 		      tls_set = 0;
   4523  1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = TLS_LD;
   4524  1.1  christos 		      break;
   4525  1.1  christos 
   4526  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   4527  1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   4528  1.1  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
   4529  1.1  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4530  1.1  christos 
   4531  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   4532  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   4533  1.1  christos 		      if (is_local)
   4534  1.1  christos 			/* GD -> LE */
   4535  1.1  christos 			tls_set = 0;
   4536  1.1  christos 		      else
   4537  1.1  christos 			/* GD -> IE */
   4538  1.1  christos 			tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
   4539  1.1  christos 		      tls_clear = TLS_GD;
   4540  1.1  christos 		      break;
   4541  1.1  christos 
   4542  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   4543  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   4544  1.1  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   4545  1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   4546  1.9  christos 		      if (is_local)
   4547  1.9  christos 			{
   4548  1.9  christos 			  /* IE -> LE */
   4549  1.1  christos 			  tls_set = 0;
   4550  1.8  christos 			  tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
   4551  1.8  christos 			  break;
   4552  1.8  christos 			}
   4553  1.8  christos 		      else
   4554  1.8  christos 			continue;
   4555  1.8  christos 
   4556  1.8  christos 		    case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   4557  1.8  christos 		      if (!is_local)
   4558  1.8  christos 			continue;
   4559  1.8  christos 		      /* Fall through.  */
   4560  1.8  christos 		    case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   4561  1.8  christos 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4562  1.8  christos 			  && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   4563  1.8  christos 			{
   4564  1.8  christos 			  if (pass != 0
   4565  1.8  christos 			      && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
   4566  1.8  christos 			    {
   4567  1.8  christos 			      r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
   4568  1.8  christos 			      r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
   4569  1.8  christos 			      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   4570  1.8  christos 				{
   4571  1.8  christos 				  struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   4572  1.8  christos 
   4573  1.8  christos 				  sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
   4574  1.8  christos 				  h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   4575  1.8  christos 				  while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   4576  1.8  christos 					 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   4577  1.8  christos 				    h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
   4578  1.8  christos 				  if (h != NULL)
   4579  1.8  christos 				    {
   4580  1.8  christos 				      struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
   4581  1.8  christos 				      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4582  1.8  christos 
   4583  1.8  christos 				      if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4584  1.1  christos 					addend = rel->r_addend;
   4585  1.1  christos 				      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
   4586  1.1  christos 							  got2, addend);
   4587  1.1  christos 				      if (ent != NULL
   4588  1.1  christos 					  && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4589  1.9  christos 					ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4590  1.9  christos 				    }
   4591  1.9  christos 				}
   4592  1.9  christos 			    }
   4593  1.9  christos 			  continue;
   4594  1.9  christos 			}
   4595  1.9  christos 		      expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
   4596  1.9  christos 		      tls_set = 0;
   4597  1.9  christos 		      tls_clear = 0;
   4598  1.9  christos 		      break;
   4599  1.9  christos 
   4600  1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   4601  1.9  christos 		      if (pass == 0)
   4602  1.9  christos 			{
   4603  1.9  christos 			  unsigned char buf[4];
   4604  1.9  christos 			  unsigned int insn;
   4605  1.9  christos 			  bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
   4606  1.9  christos 			  if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
   4607  1.9  christos 							 off, 4))
   4608  1.9  christos 			    {
   4609  1.9  christos 			      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4610  1.9  christos 				free (relstart);
   4611  1.9  christos 			      return FALSE;
   4612  1.9  christos 			    }
   4613  1.9  christos 			  insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
   4614  1.9  christos 			  /* addis rt,2,imm */
   4615  1.9  christos 			  if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
   4616  1.9  christos 			      != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
   4617  1.9  christos 			    {
   4618  1.9  christos 			      /* xgettext:c-format */
   4619  1.9  christos 			      info->callbacks->minfo
   4620  1.1  christos 				(_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
   4621  1.1  christos 				 ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
   4622  1.1  christos 			      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
   4623  1.1  christos 			    }
   4624  1.1  christos 			}
   4625  1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4626  1.1  christos 
   4627  1.9  christos 		    case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   4628  1.1  christos 		      htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
   4629  1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4630  1.1  christos 
   4631  1.1  christos 		    default:
   4632  1.1  christos 		      continue;
   4633  1.1  christos 		    }
   4634  1.1  christos 
   4635  1.1  christos 		  if (pass == 0)
   4636  1.1  christos 		    {
   4637  1.1  christos 		      if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
   4638  1.1  christos 			  || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
   4639  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4640  1.1  christos 
   4641  1.1  christos 		      if (rel + 1 < relend
   4642  1.1  christos 			  && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
   4643  1.1  christos 						      htab->tls_get_addr))
   4644  1.1  christos 			continue;
   4645  1.1  christos 
   4646  1.1  christos 		      /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call.  We
   4647  1.1  christos 			 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
   4648  1.1  christos 			 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
   4649  1.1  christos 			 the entire optimization.  */
   4650  1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
   4651  1.1  christos 						"TLS optimization disabled\n"),
   4652  1.1  christos 					      ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
   4653  1.1  christos 		      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4654  1.1  christos 			free (relstart);
   4655  1.1  christos 		      return TRUE;
   4656  1.8  christos 		    }
   4657  1.1  christos 
   4658  1.1  christos 		  if (h != NULL)
   4659  1.1  christos 		    {
   4660  1.1  christos 		      tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
   4661  1.1  christos 		      got_count = &h->got.refcount;
   4662  1.1  christos 		    }
   4663  1.8  christos 		  else
   4664  1.8  christos 		    {
   4665  1.1  christos 		      bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
   4666  1.1  christos 		      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   4667  1.1  christos 		      unsigned char *lgot_masks;
   4668  1.1  christos 
   4669  1.8  christos 		      lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   4670  1.8  christos 		      if (lgot_refs == NULL)
   4671  1.8  christos 			abort ();
   4672  1.8  christos 		      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   4673  1.8  christos 			(lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4674  1.8  christos 		      lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
   4675  1.8  christos 			(local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   4676  1.8  christos 		      tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   4677  1.9  christos 		      got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
   4678  1.8  christos 		    }
   4679  1.8  christos 
   4680  1.8  christos 		  /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
   4681  1.8  christos 		     without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
   4682  1.9  christos 		     found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
   4683  1.8  christos 		     marker for this symbol, then we either have a
   4684  1.8  christos 		     broken object file or an -mlongcall style
   4685  1.8  christos 		     indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
   4686  1.8  christos 		     Disable optimization in this case.  */
   4687  1.8  christos 		  if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
   4688  1.8  christos 		      && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
   4689  1.8  christos 		      && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
   4690  1.8  christos 			  != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
   4691  1.8  christos 		    continue;
   4692  1.8  christos 
   4693  1.8  christos 		  if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
   4694  1.8  christos 		    {
   4695  1.8  christos 		      struct plt_entry *ent;
   4696  1.9  christos 		      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   4697  1.9  christos 
   4698  1.8  christos 		      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   4699  1.1  christos 			  && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   4700  1.1  christos 			      || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
   4701  1.1  christos 			addend = rel[1].r_addend;
   4702  1.1  christos 		      ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
   4703  1.1  christos 					  got2, addend);
   4704  1.1  christos 		      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4705  1.1  christos 			ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
   4706  1.1  christos 		    }
   4707  1.1  christos 		  if (tls_clear == 0)
   4708  1.1  christos 		    continue;
   4709  1.1  christos 
   4710  1.1  christos 		  if (tls_set == 0)
   4711  1.1  christos 		    {
   4712  1.1  christos 		      /* We managed to get rid of a got entry.  */
   4713  1.1  christos 		      if (*got_count > 0)
   4714  1.1  christos 			*got_count -= 1;
   4715  1.1  christos 		    }
   4716  1.1  christos 
   4717  1.8  christos 		  *tls_mask |= tls_set;
   4718  1.8  christos 		  *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
   4719  1.8  christos 		}
   4720  1.8  christos 
   4721  1.8  christos 	      if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
   4722  1.8  christos 		free (relstart);
   4723  1.8  christos 	    }
   4724  1.8  christos       }
   4725  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   4726  1.8  christos }
   4727  1.9  christos 
   4728  1.1  christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
   4730  1.8  christos    aliases, that apply to read-only sections.  Cannot be used after
   4731  1.8  christos    size_dynamic_sections.  */
   4732  1.8  christos 
   4733  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   4734  1.8  christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4735  1.8  christos {
   4736  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
   4737  1.8  christos   do
   4738  1.8  christos     {
   4739  1.8  christos       if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
   4740  1.8  christos 	return TRUE;
   4741  1.8  christos       eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
   4742  1.9  christos     } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
   4743  1.8  christos 
   4744  1.8  christos   return FALSE;
   4745  1.1  christos }
   4746  1.1  christos 
   4747  1.1  christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs.  */
   4748  1.1  christos 
   4749  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4750  1.1  christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4751  1.1  christos {
   4752  1.1  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   4753  1.1  christos 
   4754  1.1  christos   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   4755  1.1  christos     if (p->pc_count != 0)
   4756  1.1  christos       return TRUE;
   4757  1.1  christos   return FALSE;
   4758  1.1  christos }
   4759  1.1  christos 
   4760  1.1  christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
   4761  1.1  christos    regular object.  The current definition is in some section of the
   4762  1.1  christos    dynamic object, but we're not including those sections.  We have to
   4763  1.1  christos    change the definition to something the rest of the link can
   4764  1.1  christos    understand.  */
   4765  1.1  christos 
   4766  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4767  1.1  christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   4768  1.1  christos 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   4769  1.1  christos {
   4770  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   4771  1.8  christos   asection *s;
   4772  1.1  christos 
   4773  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   4774  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
   4775  1.1  christos 	   h->root.root.string);
   4776  1.1  christos #endif
   4777  1.1  christos 
   4778  1.1  christos   /* Make sure we know what is going on here.  */
   4779  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4780  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
   4781  1.8  christos 	      && (h->needs_plt
   4782  1.8  christos 		  || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4783  1.8  christos 		  || h->is_weakalias
   4784  1.8  christos 		  || (h->def_dynamic
   4785  1.8  christos 		      && h->ref_regular
   4786  1.9  christos 		      && !h->def_regular)));
   4787  1.8  christos 
   4788  1.1  christos   /* Deal with function syms.  */
   4789  1.1  christos   if (h->type == STT_FUNC
   4790  1.1  christos       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4791  1.1  christos       || h->needs_plt)
   4792  1.1  christos     {
   4793  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   4794  1.1  christos 			   || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
   4795  1.1  christos       /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
   4796  1.8  christos 	 function symbol is local.  */
   4797  1.8  christos       if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
   4798  1.8  christos 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4799  1.8  christos 
   4800  1.1  christos       /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
   4801  1.1  christos 	 won't need a .plt entry.  */
   4802  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   4803  1.1  christos       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   4804  1.1  christos 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   4805  1.1  christos 	  break;
   4806  1.1  christos       if (ent == NULL
   4807  1.1  christos 	  || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
   4808  1.1  christos 	      && local
   4809  1.1  christos 	      && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   4810  1.1  christos 		  || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   4811  1.1  christos 		      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
   4812  1.1  christos 	{
   4813  1.3  christos 	  /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
   4814  1.1  christos 
   4815  1.1  christos 	     1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
   4816  1.1  christos 	     can't be set up, so we can't use one.  In this case,
   4817  1.3  christos 	     ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
   4818  1.3  christos 
   4819  1.3  christos 	     2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
   4820  1.7  christos 
   4821  1.7  christos 	     3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
   4822  1.7  christos 	     will go to this object, or will remain undefined.  */
   4823  1.7  christos 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4824  1.7  christos 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   4825  1.7  christos 	  h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4826  1.7  christos 	}
   4827  1.8  christos       else
   4828  1.8  christos 	{
   4829  1.8  christos 	  /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
   4830  1.9  christos 	     doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
   4831  1.3  christos 	     executable on a plt call stub.  A dynamic reloc can
   4832  1.9  christos 	     be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
   4833  1.3  christos 	     (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
   4834  1.3  christos 	     through the plt call stub.)  Similarly, use a dynamic
   4835  1.8  christos 	     reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
   4836  1.8  christos 	     resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
   4837  1.8  christos 	     than link time.  */
   4838  1.8  christos 	  if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
   4839  1.8  christos 	       || (h->non_got_ref
   4840  1.8  christos 		   && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
   4841  1.8  christos 		   && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
   4842  1.8  christos 	      && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   4843  1.9  christos 	      && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4844  1.1  christos 	      && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4845  1.5  christos 	    {
   4846  1.8  christos 	      h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
   4847  1.1  christos 	      /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
   4848  1.1  christos 		 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry.  */
   4849  1.1  christos 	      if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   4850  1.1  christos 		h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4851  1.1  christos 	    }
   4852  1.1  christos 	  else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   4853  1.1  christos 	    /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
   4854  1.1  christos 	       plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic.  */
   4855  1.8  christos 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4856  1.1  christos 	}
   4857  1.8  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4858  1.8  christos       /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs.  */
   4859  1.8  christos       return TRUE;
   4860  1.8  christos     }
   4861  1.8  christos   else
   4862  1.8  christos     h->plt.plist = NULL;
   4863  1.8  christos 
   4864  1.9  christos   /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
   4865  1.1  christos      processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
   4866  1.1  christos      real definition first, and we can just use the same value.  */
   4867  1.1  christos   if (h->is_weakalias)
   4868  1.1  christos     {
   4869  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
   4870  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
   4871  1.1  christos       h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
   4872  1.1  christos       h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
   4873  1.1  christos       if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
   4874  1.1  christos 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   4875  1.6  christos 	  || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
   4876  1.5  christos 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4877  1.5  christos       return TRUE;
   4878  1.5  christos     }
   4879  1.5  christos 
   4880  1.1  christos   /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
   4881  1.1  christos      is not a function.  */
   4882  1.1  christos 
   4883  1.1  christos   /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
   4884  1.5  christos      only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
   4885  1.5  christos      For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
   4886  1.5  christos      be handled correctly by relocate_section.  */
   4887  1.5  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4888  1.5  christos     {
   4889  1.5  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4890  1.5  christos       return TRUE;
   4891  1.5  christos     }
   4892  1.5  christos 
   4893  1.5  christos   /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
   4894  1.5  christos      GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc.  */
   4895  1.5  christos   if (!h->non_got_ref)
   4896  1.5  christos     {
   4897  1.5  christos       h->protected_def = 0;
   4898  1.5  christos       return TRUE;
   4899  1.5  christos     }
   4900  1.5  christos 
   4901  1.5  christos   /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss.  The copy in
   4902  1.5  christos      .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
   4903  1.5  christos      definition for the variable.  Editing to PIC, or text relocations
   4904  1.5  christos      are preferable to an incorrect program.  */
   4905  1.5  christos   if (h->protected_def)
   4906  1.8  christos     {
   4907  1.1  christos       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4908  1.8  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   4909  1.1  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   4910  1.1  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
   4911  1.1  christos 	  && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
   4912  1.1  christos 	htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
   4913  1.1  christos       return TRUE;
   4914  1.1  christos     }
   4915  1.1  christos 
   4916  1.9  christos   /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either.  */
   4917  1.1  christos   if (info->nocopyreloc)
   4918  1.8  christos     return TRUE;
   4919  1.8  christos 
   4920  1.1  christos    /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
   4921  1.1  christos       we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
   4922  1.1  christos       We can't do this if there are any small data relocations.  This
   4923  1.1  christos       doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
   4924  1.1  christos       relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
   4925  1.1  christos       executable.  */
   4926  1.1  christos   if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   4927  1.1  christos       && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
   4928  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
   4929  1.1  christos       && !h->def_regular
   4930  1.1  christos       && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
   4931  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   4932  1.1  christos 
   4933  1.1  christos   /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
   4934  1.1  christos      become part of the .bss section of the executable.  There will be
   4935  1.7  christos      an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section.  The dynamic
   4936  1.7  christos      object will contain position independent code, so all references
   4937  1.1  christos      from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
   4938  1.7  christos      offset table.  The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
   4939  1.1  christos      determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
   4940  1.1  christos      both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
   4941  1.1  christos      same memory location for the variable.
   4942  1.1  christos 
   4943  1.1  christos      Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
   4944  1.1  christos      must instead allocate it in .sbss.  */
   4945  1.8  christos   if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4946  1.8  christos     s = htab->dynsbss;
   4947  1.8  christos   else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4948  1.1  christos     s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
   4949  1.1  christos   else
   4950  1.7  christos     s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
   4951  1.7  christos   BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   4952  1.1  christos 
   4953  1.7  christos   if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
   4954  1.1  christos     {
   4955  1.1  christos       asection *srel;
   4956  1.1  christos 
   4957  1.1  christos       /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
   4958  1.1  christos 	 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
   4959  1.8  christos 	 and into the runtime process image.  */
   4960  1.9  christos       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   4961  1.3  christos 	srel = htab->relsbss;
   4962  1.1  christos       else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
   4963  1.1  christos 	srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   4964  1.1  christos       else
   4965  1.1  christos 	srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
   4966  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
   4967  1.1  christos       srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   4968  1.1  christos       h->needs_copy = 1;
   4969  1.1  christos     }
   4970  1.1  christos 
   4971  1.1  christos   /* We no longer want dyn_relocs.  */
   4972  1.1  christos   h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   4973  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
   4974  1.1  christos }
   4975  1.1  christos 
   4976  1.1  christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs.  For non-PIC code the sym is
   4978  1.1  christos    xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
   4979  1.1  christos    specifying the addend on the plt relocation.  For -fpic code, the sym
   4980  1.1  christos    is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
   4981  1.6  christos    xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>.  */
   4982  1.1  christos 
   4983  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   4984  1.1  christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
   4985  1.1  christos 	      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   4986  1.1  christos 	      struct bfd_link_info *info)
   4987  1.1  christos {
   4988  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   4989  1.1  christos   size_t len1, len2, len3;
   4990  1.1  christos   char *name;
   4991  1.1  christos   const char *stub;
   4992  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   4993  1.1  christos 
   4994  1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   4995  1.1  christos     stub = ".plt_pic32.";
   4996  1.1  christos   else
   4997  1.1  christos     stub = ".plt_call32.";
   4998  1.1  christos 
   4999  1.1  christos   len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
   5000  1.1  christos   len2 = strlen (stub);
   5001  1.1  christos   len3 = 0;
   5002  1.1  christos   if (ent->sec)
   5003  1.1  christos     len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
   5004  1.1  christos   name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
   5005  1.1  christos   if (name == NULL)
   5006  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   5007  1.1  christos   sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
   5008  1.1  christos   if (ent->sec)
   5009  1.1  christos     memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
   5010  1.1  christos   memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
   5011  1.1  christos   memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
   5012  1.5  christos   sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
   5013  1.1  christos   if (sh == NULL)
   5014  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   5015  1.1  christos   if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5016  1.1  christos     {
   5017  1.1  christos       sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5018  1.1  christos       sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5019  1.1  christos       sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
   5020  1.1  christos       sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5021  1.1  christos       sh->def_regular = 1;
   5022  1.1  christos       sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5023  1.1  christos       sh->forced_local = 1;
   5024  1.1  christos       sh->non_elf = 0;
   5025  1.1  christos       sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5026  1.1  christos     }
   5027  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5028  1.7  christos }
   5029  1.7  christos 
   5030  1.1  christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
   5031  1.1  christos    Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k.  */
   5032  1.1  christos 
   5033  1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   5034  1.1  christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
   5035  1.1  christos {
   5036  1.1  christos   bfd_vma where;
   5037  1.1  christos   unsigned int max_before_header;
   5038  1.1  christos 
   5039  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5040  1.1  christos     {
   5041  1.7  christos       where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5042  1.7  christos       htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5043  1.1  christos     }
   5044  1.7  christos   else
   5045  1.7  christos     {
   5046  1.1  christos       max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
   5047  1.7  christos       if (need <= htab->got_gap)
   5048  1.7  christos 	{
   5049  1.1  christos 	  where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
   5050  1.1  christos 	  htab->got_gap -= need;
   5051  1.1  christos 	}
   5052  1.1  christos       else
   5053  1.1  christos 	{
   5054  1.8  christos 	  if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
   5055  1.8  christos 	      && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
   5056  1.8  christos 	    {
   5057  1.8  christos 	      htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5058  1.8  christos 	      htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
   5059  1.8  christos 	    }
   5060  1.8  christos 	  where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5061  1.8  christos 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
   5062  1.8  christos 	}
   5063  1.8  christos     }
   5064  1.8  christos   return where;
   5065  1.8  christos }
   5066  1.8  christos 
   5067  1.8  christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
   5068  1.9  christos    TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot.  */
   5069  1.8  christos 
   5070  1.8  christos static inline unsigned int
   5071  1.8  christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
   5072  1.8  christos {
   5073  1.8  christos   unsigned int need;
   5074  1.8  christos   if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
   5075  1.8  christos     need = 4;
   5076  1.8  christos   else
   5077  1.7  christos     {
   5078  1.7  christos       need = 0;
   5079  1.8  christos       if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   5080  1.8  christos 	need += 8;
   5081  1.7  christos       if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
   5082  1.7  christos 	need += 4;
   5083  1.7  christos       if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   5084  1.7  christos 	need += 4;
   5085  1.8  christos     }
   5086  1.8  christos   return need;
   5087  1.8  christos }
   5088  1.7  christos 
   5089  1.7  christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense.  */
   5090  1.7  christos 
   5091  1.7  christos static bfd_boolean
   5092  1.7  christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
   5093  1.7  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5094  1.7  christos {
   5095  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
   5096  1.1  christos 
   5097  1.1  christos   if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
   5098  1.1  christos       && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
   5099  1.1  christos 	   && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   5100  1.1  christos 	  || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   5101  1.1  christos       && h->dynindx == -1
   5102  1.1  christos       && !h->forced_local
   5103  1.1  christos       && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
   5104  1.7  christos     return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
   5105  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5106  1.1  christos }
   5107  1.1  christos 
   5108  1.1  christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs.  */
   5109  1.1  christos 
   5110  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   5111  1.5  christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   5112  1.5  christos {
   5113  1.5  christos   struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
   5114  1.5  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   5115  1.5  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5116  1.5  christos   struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
   5117  1.5  christos   bfd_boolean dyn;
   5118  1.1  christos 
   5119  1.1  christos   if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
   5120  1.1  christos     return TRUE;
   5121  1.8  christos 
   5122  1.8  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5123  1.7  christos   eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   5124  1.1  christos   if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
   5125  1.1  christos       || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   5126  1.8  christos 	  && !eh->elf.def_regular
   5127  1.1  christos 	  && eh->elf.protected_def
   5128  1.9  christos 	  && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5129  1.8  christos 	  && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5130  1.8  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5131  1.8  christos     {
   5132  1.8  christos       unsigned int need;
   5133  1.8  christos 
   5134  1.1  christos       /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5135  1.1  christos       if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
   5136  1.8  christos 	return FALSE;
   5137  1.1  christos 
   5138  1.1  christos       need = 0;
   5139  1.1  christos       if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5140  1.1  christos 	{
   5141  1.1  christos 	  if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
   5142  1.9  christos 	    /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset.  This should
   5143  1.9  christos 	       always be the case.  It's a little odd if we have
   5144  1.9  christos 	       a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol.  */
   5145  1.9  christos 	    htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5146  1.7  christos 	  else
   5147  1.7  christos 	    need += 8;
   5148  1.7  christos 	}
   5149  1.8  christos       need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
   5150  1.1  christos       if (need == 0)
   5151  1.8  christos 	eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5152  1.9  christos       else
   5153  1.9  christos 	{
   5154  1.9  christos 	  eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5155  1.8  christos 	  if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
   5156  1.8  christos 		&& !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5157  1.1  christos 		     && bfd_link_executable (info)
   5158  1.7  christos 		     && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
   5159  1.8  christos 	       || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5160  1.1  christos 		   && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
   5161  1.1  christos 		   && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
   5162  1.1  christos 	      && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
   5163  1.1  christos 	    {
   5164  1.1  christos 	      asection *rsec;
   5165  1.1  christos 
   5166  1.8  christos 	      need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5167  1.8  christos 	      if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5168  1.7  christos 		need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5169  1.7  christos 	      rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5170  1.9  christos 	      if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5171  1.7  christos 		rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5172  1.8  christos 	      rsec->size += need;
   5173  1.8  christos 	    }
   5174  1.8  christos 	}
   5175  1.9  christos     }
   5176  1.8  christos   else
   5177  1.8  christos     eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5178  1.8  christos 
   5179  1.8  christos   /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
   5180  1.9  christos      IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables.  */
   5181  1.8  christos   if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5182  1.9  christos       && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5183  1.7  christos     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5184  1.1  christos 
   5185  1.1  christos   /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local.  */
   5186  1.1  christos   else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   5187  1.1  christos 	   && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
   5188  1.1  christos     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5189  1.1  christos 
   5190  1.7  christos   /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
   5191  1.1  christos      visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so.  */
   5192  1.1  christos   else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   5193  1.1  christos     h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5194  1.1  christos 
   5195  1.1  christos   if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
   5196  1.1  christos     ;
   5197  1.1  christos 
   5198  1.1  christos   /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
   5199  1.1  christos      dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
   5200  1.1  christos      defined in regular objects.  For the normal shared case, discard
   5201  1.1  christos      space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
   5202  1.9  christos      changes.  */
   5203  1.1  christos   else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5204  1.1  christos     {
   5205  1.1  christos       /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
   5206  1.1  christos 	 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
   5207  1.1  christos 	 generated via assembly.  We want calls to protected symbols to
   5208  1.1  christos 	 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
   5209  1.1  christos 	 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
   5210  1.1  christos 	 then they should avoid writing weird assembly.  */
   5211  1.1  christos       if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
   5212  1.1  christos 	{
   5213  1.9  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5214  1.1  christos 
   5215  1.1  christos 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5216  1.1  christos 	    {
   5217  1.9  christos 	      p->count -= p->pc_count;
   5218  1.1  christos 	      p->pc_count = 0;
   5219  1.1  christos 	      if (p->count == 0)
   5220  1.1  christos 		*pp = p->next;
   5221  1.1  christos 	      else
   5222  1.1  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   5223  1.1  christos 	    }
   5224  1.1  christos 	}
   5225  1.1  christos 
   5226  1.9  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   5227  1.1  christos 	{
   5228  1.8  christos 	  struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
   5229  1.8  christos 
   5230  1.7  christos 	  for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
   5231  1.1  christos 	    {
   5232  1.1  christos 	      if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5233  1.1  christos 		*pp = p->next;
   5234  1.1  christos 	      else
   5235  1.7  christos 		pp = &p->next;
   5236  1.1  christos 	    }
   5237  1.1  christos 	}
   5238  1.8  christos 
   5239  1.5  christos       if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   5240  1.8  christos 	{
   5241  1.5  christos 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5242  1.5  christos 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5243  1.5  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5244  1.5  christos 	}
   5245  1.1  christos     }
   5246  1.8  christos   else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
   5247  1.8  christos     {
   5248  1.7  christos       /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
   5249  1.1  christos 	 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
   5250  1.7  christos 	 dynamic.  */
   5251  1.9  christos       if (h->dynamic_adjusted
   5252  1.1  christos 	  && !h->def_regular
   5253  1.7  christos 	  && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
   5254  1.9  christos 	  && !(h->protected_def
   5255  1.1  christos 	       && eh->has_addr16_ha
   5256  1.1  christos 	       && eh->has_addr16_lo
   5257  1.7  christos 	       && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
   5258  1.9  christos 	{
   5259  1.1  christos 	  /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol.  */
   5260  1.1  christos 	  if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
   5261  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5262  1.7  christos 
   5263  1.1  christos 	  if (h->dynindx == -1)
   5264  1.1  christos 	    h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5265  1.1  christos 	}
   5266  1.8  christos       else
   5267  1.8  christos 	h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
   5268  1.8  christos     }
   5269  1.8  christos 
   5270  1.8  christos   /* Allocate space.  */
   5271  1.8  christos   for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
   5272  1.7  christos     {
   5273  1.8  christos       asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5274  1.8  christos       if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5275  1.8  christos 	sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5276  1.8  christos       sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5277  1.8  christos     }
   5278  1.8  christos 
   5279  1.8  christos   /* Handle PLT relocs.  Done last, after dynindx has settled.
   5280  1.8  christos      We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
   5281  1.8  christos      a) is dynamic, or
   5282  1.7  christos      b) is an ifunc, or
   5283  1.7  christos      c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
   5284  1.7  christos      d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically.  */
   5285  1.8  christos   dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
   5286  1.7  christos   if (dyn
   5287  1.7  christos       || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   5288  1.7  christos       || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
   5289  1.7  christos       || (h->needs_plt
   5290  1.7  christos 	  && h->def_regular
   5291  1.7  christos 	  && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   5292  1.7  christos 	  && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5293  1.8  christos 	  && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
   5294  1.8  christos 	      & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
   5295  1.8  christos     {
   5296  1.8  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   5297  1.8  christos       bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
   5298  1.8  christos       bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5299  1.7  christos 
   5300  1.7  christos       for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5301  1.7  christos 	if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5302  1.7  christos 	  {
   5303  1.7  christos 	    asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
   5304  1.7  christos 
   5305  1.7  christos 	    if (!dyn)
   5306  1.7  christos 	      {
   5307  1.7  christos 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5308  1.7  christos 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5309  1.8  christos 		else
   5310  1.8  christos 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5311  1.8  christos 	      }
   5312  1.7  christos 
   5313  1.8  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
   5314  1.8  christos 	      {
   5315  1.8  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5316  1.8  christos 		  {
   5317  1.8  christos 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5318  1.8  christos 		    s->size += 4;
   5319  1.8  christos 		  }
   5320  1.8  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5321  1.8  christos 
   5322  1.8  christos 		if (s == htab->pltlocal)
   5323  1.8  christos 		  ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5324  1.8  christos 		else
   5325  1.8  christos 		  {
   5326  1.8  christos 		    s = htab->glink;
   5327  1.8  christos 		    if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
   5328  1.8  christos 		      {
   5329  1.8  christos 			glink_offset = s->size;
   5330  1.8  christos 			s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   5331  1.8  christos 		      }
   5332  1.7  christos 		    if (!doneone
   5333  1.7  christos 			&& !bfd_link_pic (info)
   5334  1.7  christos 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5335  1.7  christos 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5336  1.7  christos 		      {
   5337  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5338  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
   5339  1.7  christos 		      }
   5340  1.7  christos 		    ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5341  1.7  christos 
   5342  1.7  christos 		    if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
   5343  1.7  christos 			&& !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
   5344  1.7  christos 		      return FALSE;
   5345  1.7  christos 		  }
   5346  1.7  christos 	      }
   5347  1.7  christos 	    else
   5348  1.7  christos 	      {
   5349  1.7  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5350  1.7  christos 		  {
   5351  1.7  christos 		    /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
   5352  1.7  christos 		       for the special first entry.  */
   5353  1.7  christos 		    if (s->size == 0)
   5354  1.7  christos 		      s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
   5355  1.7  christos 
   5356  1.7  christos 		    /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
   5357  1.7  christos 		       parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
   5358  1.7  christos 		       and a jump), and then there is a remaining
   5359  1.7  christos 		       word available at the end.  */
   5360  1.7  christos 		    plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
   5361  1.7  christos 				  + (htab->plt_slot_size
   5362  1.7  christos 				     * ((s->size
   5363  1.7  christos 					 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5364  1.7  christos 					/ htab->plt_entry_size)));
   5365  1.7  christos 
   5366  1.7  christos 		    /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
   5367  1.7  christos 		       file, and we are not generating a shared
   5368  1.7  christos 		       library, then set the symbol to this location
   5369  1.7  christos 		       in the .plt.  This is to avoid text
   5370  1.7  christos 		       relocations, and is required to make
   5371  1.7  christos 		       function pointers compare as equal between
   5372  1.7  christos 		       the normal executable and the shared library.  */
   5373  1.7  christos 		    if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
   5374  1.7  christos 			&& h->def_dynamic
   5375  1.7  christos 			&& !h->def_regular)
   5376  1.7  christos 		      {
   5377  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.section = s;
   5378  1.7  christos 			h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
   5379  1.7  christos 		      }
   5380  1.7  christos 
   5381  1.7  christos 		    /* Make room for this entry.  */
   5382  1.7  christos 		    s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5383  1.7  christos 		    /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
   5384  1.7  christos 		       is allocated.  */
   5385  1.8  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
   5386  1.8  christos 			&& (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5387  1.8  christos 			/ htab->plt_entry_size
   5388  1.8  christos 			> PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
   5389  1.8  christos 		      s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
   5390  1.8  christos 		  }
   5391  1.8  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5392  1.8  christos 	      }
   5393  1.8  christos 
   5394  1.8  christos 	    /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   5395  1.8  christos 	    if (!doneone)
   5396  1.8  christos 	      {
   5397  1.7  christos 		if (!dyn)
   5398  1.7  christos 		  {
   5399  1.7  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   5400  1.7  christos 		      {
   5401  1.7  christos 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5402  1.7  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5403  1.7  christos 		      }
   5404  1.7  christos 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5405  1.7  christos 		      {
   5406  1.7  christos 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5407  1.7  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5408  1.7  christos 		      }
   5409  1.7  christos 		  }
   5410  1.7  christos 		else
   5411  1.7  christos 		  {
   5412  1.7  christos 		    htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5413  1.7  christos 
   5414  1.7  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
   5415  1.7  christos 		      {
   5416  1.7  christos 			/* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations.  */
   5417  1.7  christos 			if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   5418  1.7  christos 			    && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5419  1.7  christos 			  {
   5420  1.7  christos 			    if (ent->plt.offset
   5421  1.7  christos 				== (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   5422  1.7  christos 			      {
   5423  1.7  christos 				htab->srelplt2->size
   5424  1.7  christos 				  += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5425  1.7  christos 				      * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
   5426  1.7  christos 			      }
   5427  1.7  christos 
   5428  1.7  christos 			    htab->srelplt2->size
   5429  1.7  christos 			      += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
   5430  1.7  christos 				  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
   5431  1.7  christos 			  }
   5432  1.7  christos 
   5433  1.7  christos 			/* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
   5434  1.7  christos 			   .got.plt.  */
   5435  1.7  christos 			htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
   5436  1.7  christos 		      }
   5437  1.7  christos 		  }
   5438  1.7  christos 		doneone = TRUE;
   5439  1.7  christos 	      }
   5440  1.7  christos 	  }
   5441  1.7  christos 	else
   5442  1.7  christos 	  ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5443  1.1  christos 
   5444  1.1  christos       if (!doneone)
   5445  1.1  christos 	{
   5446  1.1  christos 	  h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5447  1.1  christos 	  h->needs_plt = 0;
   5448  1.1  christos 	}
   5449  1.1  christos     }
   5450  1.1  christos   else
   5451  1.1  christos     {
   5452  1.1  christos       h->plt.plist = NULL;
   5453  1.1  christos       h->needs_plt = 0;
   5454  1.1  christos     }
   5455  1.1  christos 
   5456  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   5457  1.1  christos }
   5458  1.1  christos 
   5459  1.1  christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
   5460  1.1  christos {
   5461  1.1  christos   0, 0, 0, 16,				/* length.  */
   5462  1.1  christos   0, 0, 0, 0,				/* id.  */
   5463  1.3  christos   1,					/* CIE version.  */
   5464  1.1  christos   'z', 'R', 0,				/* Augmentation string.  */
   5465  1.1  christos   4,					/* Code alignment.  */
   5466  1.1  christos   0x7c,					/* Data alignment.  */
   5467  1.1  christos   65,					/* RA reg.  */
   5468  1.1  christos   1,					/* Augmentation size.  */
   5469  1.1  christos   DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4,	/* FDE encoding.  */
   5470  1.1  christos   DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0			/* def_cfa: r1 offset 0.  */
   5471  1.1  christos };
   5472  1.1  christos 
   5473  1.1  christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections.  */
   5474  1.1  christos 
   5475  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   5476  1.1  christos ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   5477  1.1  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info)
   5478  1.1  christos {
   5479  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   5480  1.1  christos   asection *s;
   5481  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean relocs;
   5482  1.1  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   5483  1.1  christos 
   5484  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   5485  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
   5486  1.1  christos #endif
   5487  1.1  christos 
   5488  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5489  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
   5490  1.1  christos 
   5491  1.1  christos   if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
   5492  1.1  christos     {
   5493  1.1  christos       /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter.  */
   5494  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
   5495  1.1  christos 	{
   5496  1.1  christos 	  s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
   5497  1.3  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   5498  1.1  christos 	  s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5499  1.1  christos 	  s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
   5500  1.1  christos 	}
   5501  1.1  christos     }
   5502  1.1  christos 
   5503  1.1  christos   if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5504  1.1  christos     htab->got_header_size = 16;
   5505  1.1  christos   else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   5506  1.1  christos     htab->got_header_size = 12;
   5507  1.1  christos 
   5508  1.1  christos   /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
   5509  1.1  christos      relocs.  */
   5510  1.1  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   5511  1.1  christos     {
   5512  1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
   5513  1.1  christos       bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
   5514  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   5515  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
   5516  1.1  christos       char *lgot_masks;
   5517  1.1  christos       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   5518  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   5519  1.1  christos 
   5520  1.1  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   5521  1.1  christos 	continue;
   5522  1.1  christos 
   5523  1.1  christos       for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5524  1.1  christos 	{
   5525  1.1  christos 	  struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
   5526  1.1  christos 
   5527  1.9  christos 	  for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
   5528  1.1  christos 		    elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
   5529  1.1  christos 	       p != NULL;
   5530  1.1  christos 	       p = p->next)
   5531  1.1  christos 	    {
   5532  1.1  christos 	      if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
   5533  1.1  christos 		  && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
   5534  1.1  christos 		{
   5535  1.1  christos 		  /* Input section has been discarded, either because
   5536  1.1  christos 		     it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
   5537  1.1  christos 		     linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
   5538  1.7  christos 		     the relocs too.  */
   5539  1.1  christos 		}
   5540  1.1  christos 	      else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   5541  1.1  christos 		       && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
   5542  1.1  christos 				  ".tls_vars") == 0)
   5543  1.8  christos 		{
   5544  1.8  christos 		  /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
   5545  1.8  christos 		     handled specially by the loader.  */
   5546  1.8  christos 		}
   5547  1.8  christos 	      else if (p->count != 0)
   5548  1.1  christos 		{
   5549  1.1  christos 		  asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
   5550  1.1  christos 		  if (p->ifunc)
   5551  1.1  christos 		    sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5552  1.1  christos 		  sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5553  1.1  christos 		  if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
   5554  1.1  christos 		       & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5555  1.1  christos 		      == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
   5556  1.1  christos 		    {
   5557  1.1  christos 		      info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
   5558  1.1  christos 		      info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
   5559  1.1  christos 					      p->sec->owner, p->sec);
   5560  1.1  christos 		    }
   5561  1.1  christos 		}
   5562  1.1  christos 	    }
   5563  1.1  christos 	}
   5564  1.1  christos 
   5565  1.1  christos       local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
   5566  1.8  christos       if (!local_got)
   5567  1.8  christos 	continue;
   5568  1.8  christos 
   5569  1.8  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   5570  1.1  christos       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   5571  1.1  christos       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   5572  1.1  christos       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   5573  1.1  christos       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   5574  1.1  christos       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5575  1.9  christos 
   5576  1.9  christos       for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
   5577  1.9  christos 	if (*local_got > 0)
   5578  1.1  christos 	  {
   5579  1.8  christos 	    unsigned int need;
   5580  1.8  christos 	    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   5581  1.9  christos 	      htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
   5582  1.8  christos 	    need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
   5583  1.8  christos 	    if (need == 0)
   5584  1.7  christos 	      *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5585  1.8  christos 	    else
   5586  1.1  christos 	      {
   5587  1.1  christos 		*local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
   5588  1.1  christos 		if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5589  1.1  christos 		    && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
   5590  1.1  christos 			 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
   5591  1.1  christos 		  {
   5592  1.9  christos 		    asection *srel;
   5593  1.1  christos 
   5594  1.1  christos 		    need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
   5595  1.1  christos 		    srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
   5596  1.8  christos 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5597  1.8  christos 		      srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5598  1.1  christos 		    srel->size += need;
   5599  1.1  christos 		  }
   5600  1.1  christos 	      }
   5601  1.8  christos 	  }
   5602  1.1  christos 	else
   5603  1.1  christos 	  *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5604  1.1  christos 
   5605  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   5606  1.8  christos 	continue;
   5607  1.8  christos 
   5608  1.8  christos       /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt.  */
   5609  1.8  christos       lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
   5610  1.8  christos       for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
   5611  1.8  christos 	{
   5612  1.8  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   5613  1.8  christos 	  bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
   5614  1.8  christos 	  bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5615  1.8  christos 
   5616  1.1  christos 	  for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   5617  1.1  christos 	    if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
   5618  1.1  christos 	      {
   5619  1.1  christos 		if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5620  1.1  christos 		  s = htab->elf.iplt;
   5621  1.1  christos 		else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
   5622  1.1  christos 			 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
   5623  1.1  christos 		  {
   5624  1.8  christos 		    ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5625  1.1  christos 		    continue;
   5626  1.8  christos 		  }
   5627  1.1  christos 		else
   5628  1.8  christos 		  s = htab->pltlocal;
   5629  1.1  christos 
   5630  1.1  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5631  1.1  christos 		  {
   5632  1.1  christos 		    plt_offset = s->size;
   5633  1.1  christos 		    s->size += 4;
   5634  1.8  christos 		  }
   5635  1.8  christos 		ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
   5636  1.8  christos 
   5637  1.8  christos 		if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
   5638  1.8  christos 		  {
   5639  1.8  christos 		    s = htab->glink;
   5640  1.8  christos 		    glink_offset = s->size;
   5641  1.8  christos 		    s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
   5642  1.8  christos 		  }
   5643  1.8  christos 		ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
   5644  1.1  christos 
   5645  1.1  christos 		if (!doneone)
   5646  1.1  christos 		  {
   5647  1.1  christos 		    if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
   5648  1.1  christos 		      {
   5649  1.1  christos 			s = htab->elf.irelplt;
   5650  1.1  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5651  1.1  christos 		      }
   5652  1.1  christos 		    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5653  1.1  christos 		      {
   5654  1.1  christos 			s = htab->relpltlocal;
   5655  1.1  christos 			s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5656  1.1  christos 		      }
   5657  1.1  christos 		    doneone = TRUE;
   5658  1.9  christos 		  }
   5659  1.7  christos 	      }
   5660  1.1  christos 	    else
   5661  1.1  christos 	      ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5662  1.1  christos 	}
   5663  1.1  christos     }
   5664  1.7  christos 
   5665  1.1  christos   /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs.  */
   5666  1.1  christos   elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
   5667  1.1  christos 
   5668  1.1  christos   if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
   5669  1.1  christos     {
   5670  1.1  christos       htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
   5671  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_dll (info))
   5672  1.7  christos 	htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   5673  1.1  christos     }
   5674  1.7  christos   else
   5675  1.1  christos     htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   5676  1.1  christos 
   5677  1.7  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
   5678  1.1  christos     {
   5679  1.1  christos       unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
   5680  1.1  christos 
   5681  1.1  christos       /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now.  When we get here,
   5682  1.6  christos 	 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
   5683  1.1  christos 	 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated).  For new plt/got, the
   5684  1.1  christos 	 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536.  */
   5685  1.3  christos       if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
   5686  1.3  christos 	{
   5687  1.3  christos 	  g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
   5688  1.3  christos 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   5689  1.3  christos 	    g_o_t += 4;
   5690  1.3  christos 	  htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
   5691  1.3  christos 	}
   5692  1.3  christos 
   5693  1.3  christos       htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
   5694  1.3  christos     }
   5695  1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5696  1.3  christos     {
   5697  1.3  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5698  1.1  christos 
   5699  1.1  christos       sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
   5700  1.1  christos       sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   5701  1.1  christos     }
   5702  1.1  christos   if (info->emitrelocations)
   5703  1.1  christos     {
   5704  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   5705  1.8  christos 
   5706  1.8  christos       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5707  1.8  christos 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5708  1.1  christos       sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   5709  1.3  christos       if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
   5710  1.3  christos 	sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
   5711  1.1  christos     }
   5712  1.1  christos 
   5713  1.3  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5714  1.1  christos       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5715  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5716  1.1  christos     {
   5717  1.1  christos       htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
   5718  1.1  christos       /* Space for the branch table.  */
   5719  1.1  christos       htab->glink->size
   5720  1.1  christos 	+= htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
   5721  1.1  christos       /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve.  */
   5722  1.1  christos       htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   5723  1.1  christos 						 ? 63 : 15);
   5724  1.1  christos       htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5725  1.1  christos 
   5726  1.1  christos       if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
   5727  1.1  christos 	{
   5728  1.1  christos 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
   5729  1.1  christos 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
   5730  1.5  christos 				     TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
   5731  1.1  christos 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5732  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5733  1.1  christos 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5734  1.1  christos 	    {
   5735  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5736  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5737  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
   5738  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5739  1.1  christos 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5740  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5741  1.1  christos 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5742  1.1  christos 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5743  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5744  1.1  christos 	    }
   5745  1.1  christos 	  sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
   5746  1.5  christos 				     TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
   5747  1.1  christos 	  if (sh == NULL)
   5748  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5749  1.1  christos 	  if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
   5750  1.1  christos 	    {
   5751  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
   5752  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
   5753  1.1  christos 	      sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   5754  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular = 1;
   5755  1.1  christos 	      sh->def_regular = 1;
   5756  1.1  christos 	      sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
   5757  1.1  christos 	      sh->forced_local = 1;
   5758  1.1  christos 	      sh->non_elf = 0;
   5759  1.6  christos 	      sh->root.linker_def = 1;
   5760  1.1  christos 	    }
   5761  1.1  christos 	}
   5762  1.1  christos     }
   5763  1.1  christos 
   5764  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   5765  1.1  christos       && htab->glink->size != 0
   5766  1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5767  1.1  christos       && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
   5768  1.1  christos       && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
   5769  1.1  christos     {
   5770  1.1  christos       s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
   5771  1.1  christos       s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
   5772  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   5773  1.1  christos 	{
   5774  1.1  christos 	  s->size += 4;
   5775  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
   5776  1.1  christos 	    s->size += 4;
   5777  1.7  christos 	}
   5778  1.7  christos     }
   5779  1.1  christos 
   5780  1.1  christos   /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
   5781  1.1  christos      Allocate memory for them.  */
   5782  1.1  christos   relocs = FALSE;
   5783  1.1  christos   for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
   5784  1.1  christos     {
   5785  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
   5786  1.1  christos 
   5787  1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
   5788  1.7  christos 	continue;
   5789  1.8  christos 
   5790  1.1  christos       if (s == htab->elf.splt
   5791  1.1  christos 	  || s == htab->elf.sgot)
   5792  1.7  christos 	{
   5793  1.1  christos 	  /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
   5794  1.7  christos 	     we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
   5795  1.7  christos 	     It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols.  */
   5796  1.3  christos 	  if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
   5797  1.3  christos 	    strip_section = FALSE;
   5798  1.3  christos 	  /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
   5799  1.3  christos 	     comment below.  */
   5800  1.3  christos 	}
   5801  1.1  christos       else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
   5802  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->pltlocal
   5803  1.3  christos 	       || s == htab->glink
   5804  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
   5805  1.9  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
   5806  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->sbss
   5807  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
   5808  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
   5809  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->dynsbss)
   5810  1.1  christos 	{
   5811  1.1  christos 	  /* Strip these too.  */
   5812  1.1  christos 	}
   5813  1.1  christos       else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
   5814  1.1  christos 	       || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
   5815  1.1  christos 	{
   5816  1.1  christos 	  strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
   5817  1.1  christos 	}
   5818  1.1  christos       else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
   5819  1.1  christos 	{
   5820  1.1  christos 	  if (s->size != 0)
   5821  1.1  christos 	    {
   5822  1.1  christos 	      /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections.  */
   5823  1.1  christos 	      relocs = TRUE;
   5824  1.1  christos 
   5825  1.1  christos 	      /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
   5826  1.1  christos 		 to copy relocs into the output file.  */
   5827  1.1  christos 	      s->reloc_count = 0;
   5828  1.1  christos 	    }
   5829  1.1  christos 	}
   5830  1.1  christos       else
   5831  1.1  christos 	{
   5832  1.1  christos 	  /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space.  */
   5833  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   5834  1.1  christos 	}
   5835  1.1  christos 
   5836  1.1  christos       if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
   5837  1.1  christos 	{
   5838  1.1  christos 	  /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
   5839  1.1  christos 	     output file.  This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
   5840  1.1  christos 	     .rela.plt.  We must create both sections in
   5841  1.1  christos 	     create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
   5842  1.1  christos 	     before the linker maps input sections to output
   5843  1.1  christos 	     sections.  The linker does that before
   5844  1.1  christos 	     adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
   5845  1.1  christos 	     function which decides whether anything needs to go
   5846  1.1  christos 	     into these sections.  */
   5847  1.1  christos 	  s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
   5848  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   5849  1.1  christos 	}
   5850  1.1  christos 
   5851  1.1  christos       if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
   5852  1.1  christos 	continue;
   5853  1.1  christos 
   5854  1.1  christos       /* Allocate memory for the section contents.  */
   5855  1.1  christos       s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
   5856  1.1  christos       if (s->contents == NULL)
   5857  1.9  christos 	return FALSE;
   5858  1.9  christos     }
   5859  1.9  christos 
   5860  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5861  1.3  christos     {
   5862  1.3  christos       /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section.  We fill in the
   5863  1.3  christos 	 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
   5864  1.1  christos 	 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
   5865  1.1  christos 	 the .dynamic section.  The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
   5866  1.1  christos 	 dynamic linker and used by the debugger.  */
   5867  1.3  christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
   5868  1.1  christos   _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
   5869  1.1  christos 
   5870  1.1  christos       if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
   5871  1.1  christos 						    relocs))
   5872  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   5873  1.1  christos 
   5874  1.1  christos       if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   5875  1.1  christos 	  && htab->glink != NULL
   5876  1.1  christos 	  && htab->glink->size != 0)
   5877  1.1  christos 	{
   5878  1.1  christos 	  if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
   5879  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5880  1.1  christos 	  if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
   5881  1.1  christos 	      && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
   5882  1.1  christos 	      && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
   5883  1.1  christos 	      && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
   5884  1.1  christos 	    return FALSE;
   5885  1.1  christos 	}
   5886  1.1  christos    }
   5887  1.1  christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
   5888  1.1  christos 
   5889  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   5890  1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   5891  1.1  christos     {
   5892  1.1  christos       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5893  1.1  christos       bfd_vma val;
   5894  1.1  christos 
   5895  1.1  christos       memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
   5896  1.1  christos       /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian).  */
   5897  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
   5898  1.1  christos       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5899  1.1  christos       /* FDE length.  */
   5900  1.1  christos       val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   5901  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5902  1.6  christos       p += 4;
   5903  1.1  christos       /* CIE pointer.  */
   5904  1.1  christos       val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   5905  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   5906  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5907  1.1  christos       /* Offset to .glink.  Set later.  */
   5908  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5909  1.1  christos       /* .glink size.  */
   5910  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
   5911  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   5912  1.1  christos       /* Augmentation.  */
   5913  1.1  christos       p += 1;
   5914  1.1  christos 
   5915  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   5916  1.1  christos 	  && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   5917  1.1  christos 	{
   5918  1.1  christos 	  bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
   5919  1.1  christos 	  if (adv < 64)
   5920  1.1  christos 	    *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
   5921  1.1  christos 	  else if (adv < 256)
   5922  1.1  christos 	    {
   5923  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
   5924  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = adv;
   5925  1.1  christos 	    }
   5926  1.1  christos 	  else if (adv < 65536)
   5927  1.1  christos 	    {
   5928  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
   5929  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5930  1.1  christos 	      p += 2;
   5931  1.1  christos 	    }
   5932  1.1  christos 	  else
   5933  1.1  christos 	    {
   5934  1.1  christos 	      *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
   5935  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
   5936  1.1  christos 	      p += 4;
   5937  1.1  christos 	    }
   5938  1.1  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
   5939  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = 65;
   5940  1.3  christos 	  p++;
   5941  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
   5942  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
   5943  1.3  christos 	  *p++ = 65;
   5944  1.3  christos 	}
   5945  1.3  christos       BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
   5946  1.3  christos 		  == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
   5947  1.3  christos     }
   5948  1.3  christos 
   5949  1.3  christos   return TRUE;
   5950  1.3  christos }
   5951  1.3  christos 
   5952  1.3  christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
   5953  1.3  christos    if it looks like nothing is using them.  */
   5954  1.3  christos 
   5955  1.3  christos static void
   5956  1.3  christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
   5957  1.3  christos {
   5958  1.3  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
   5959  1.3  christos 
   5960  1.3  christos   if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
   5961  1.3  christos     {
   5962  1.3  christos       asection *s;
   5963  1.3  christos 
   5964  1.3  christos       s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
   5965  1.3  christos       if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   5966  1.3  christos 	{
   5967  1.3  christos 	  s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
   5968  1.3  christos 	  if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
   5969  1.3  christos 	    {
   5970  1.3  christos 	      sda->def_regular = 0;
   5971  1.3  christos 	      /* This is somewhat magic.  See elf_link_output_extsym.  */
   5972  1.3  christos 	      sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
   5973  1.3  christos 	      sda->forced_local = 0;
   5974  1.3  christos 	    }
   5975  1.3  christos 	}
   5976  1.3  christos     }
   5977  1.3  christos }
   5978  1.3  christos 
   5979  1.1  christos void
   5980  1.1  christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   5981  1.1  christos {
   5982  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   5983  1.1  christos 
   5984  1.1  christos   if (htab != NULL)
   5985  1.1  christos     {
   5986  1.1  christos       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
   5987  1.1  christos       maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
   5988  1.1  christos     }
   5989  1.1  christos }
   5990  1.1  christos 
   5991  1.1  christos 
   5992  1.1  christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section.  */
   5993  1.1  christos 
   5994  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   5995  1.1  christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   5996  1.1  christos {
   5997  1.1  christos   if (h->plt.plist != NULL
   5998  1.1  christos       && !h->def_regular
   5999  1.1  christos       && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
   6000  1.1  christos 	  || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
   6001  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   6002  1.1  christos 
   6003  1.3  christos   return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
   6004  1.1  christos }
   6005  1.1  christos 
   6006  1.1  christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
   6008  1.1  christos 
   6009  1.1  christos /* Relaxation trampolines.  r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
   6010  1.1  christos    used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI).  */
   6011  1.1  christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
   6012  1.1  christos   {
   6013  1.1  christos     0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
   6014  1.1  christos     0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
   6015  1.1  christos     0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
   6016  1.1  christos     0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
   6017  1.3  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
   6018  1.3  christos     0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
   6019  1.3  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6020  1.5  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6021  1.3  christos   };
   6022  1.3  christos 
   6023  1.3  christos static const int stub_entry[] =
   6024  1.3  christos   {
   6025  1.3  christos     0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
   6026  1.3  christos     0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
   6027  1.3  christos     0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
   6028  1.1  christos     0x4e800420, /* bctr */
   6029  1.1  christos   };
   6030  1.1  christos 
   6031  1.1  christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
   6032  1.1  christos {
   6033  1.1  christos   unsigned int workaround_size;
   6034  1.5  christos   unsigned int picfixup_size;
   6035  1.1  christos };
   6036  1.5  christos 
   6037  1.1  christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
   6038  1.1  christos    icache bug workaround.  Any section needing trampolines or patch
   6039  1.1  christos    space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
   6040  1.1  christos    add trampolines at the end of the section.  */
   6041  1.1  christos 
   6042  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6043  1.1  christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
   6044  1.1  christos 		       asection *isec,
   6045  1.1  christos 		       struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
   6046  1.1  christos 		       bfd_boolean *again)
   6047  1.1  christos {
   6048  1.3  christos   struct one_branch_fixup
   6049  1.5  christos   {
   6050  1.3  christos     struct one_branch_fixup *next;
   6051  1.1  christos     asection *tsec;
   6052  1.3  christos     /* Final link, can use the symbol offset.  For a
   6053  1.1  christos        relocatable link we use the symbol's index.  */
   6054  1.5  christos     bfd_vma toff;
   6055  1.1  christos     bfd_vma trampoff;
   6056  1.1  christos   };
   6057  1.1  christos 
   6058  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   6059  1.1  christos   bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
   6060  1.3  christos   Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
   6061  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
   6062  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
   6063  1.3  christos   struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
   6064  1.3  christos   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   6065  1.1  christos   unsigned changes = 0;
   6066  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean workaround_change;
   6067  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   6068  1.1  christos   bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
   6069  1.1  christos   asection *got2;
   6070  1.6  christos   bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
   6071  1.3  christos 
   6072  1.3  christos   *again = FALSE;
   6073  1.3  christos 
   6074  1.3  christos   /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections.  */
   6075  1.3  christos   if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   6076  1.3  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
   6077  1.3  christos       || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
   6078  1.3  christos       || isec->size < 4)
   6079  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6080  1.3  christos 
   6081  1.3  christos   /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
   6082  1.3  christos      do anything.  The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
   6083  1.3  christos      anyway.  */
   6084  1.3  christos   if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6085  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6086  1.5  christos 
   6087  1.5  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
   6088  1.3  christos   if (htab == NULL)
   6089  1.3  christos     return TRUE;
   6090  1.3  christos 
   6091  1.3  christos   isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
   6092  1.3  christos   if (isec->rawsize == 0)
   6093  1.3  christos     isec->rawsize = isec->size;
   6094  1.3  christos   trampbase = isec->size;
   6095  1.3  christos 
   6096  1.3  christos   BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
   6097  1.3  christos 	      || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
   6098  1.3  christos   isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
   6099  1.1  christos 
   6100  1.1  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6101  1.1  christos       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6102  1.1  christos     {
   6103  1.3  christos       if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6104  1.3  christos 	{
   6105  1.1  christos 	  elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
   6106  1.1  christos 	    = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
   6107  1.1  christos 	  if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
   6108  1.5  christos 	    return FALSE;
   6109  1.5  christos 	}
   6110  1.5  christos       relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
   6111  1.1  christos       trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
   6112  1.3  christos     }
   6113  1.3  christos 
   6114  1.1  christos   maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   6115  1.3  christos 		  || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
   6116  1.3  christos   /* Space for a branch around any trampolines.  */
   6117  1.3  christos   trampoff = trampbase;
   6118  1.3  christos   if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
   6119  1.3  christos     trampoff += 4;
   6120  1.1  christos 
   6121  1.3  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
   6122  1.1  christos   picfixup_size = 0;
   6123  1.3  christos   if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
   6124  1.3  christos       || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6125  1.3  christos     {
   6126  1.3  christos       /* Get a copy of the native relocations.  */
   6127  1.3  christos       if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
   6128  1.3  christos 	{
   6129  1.5  christos 	  internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
   6130  1.3  christos 						       link_info->keep_memory);
   6131  1.5  christos 	  if (internal_relocs == NULL)
   6132  1.3  christos 	    goto error_return;
   6133  1.3  christos 	}
   6134  1.3  christos 
   6135  1.8  christos       got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
   6136  1.3  christos 
   6137  1.3  christos       irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
   6138  1.3  christos       for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
   6139  1.3  christos 	{
   6140  1.3  christos 	  unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
   6141  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma toff, roff;
   6142  1.3  christos 	  asection *tsec;
   6143  1.3  christos 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f;
   6144  1.8  christos 	  size_t insn_offset = 0;
   6145  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
   6146  1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte *hit_addr;
   6147  1.1  christos 	  unsigned long t0;
   6148  1.3  christos 	  struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   6149  1.3  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
   6150  1.3  christos 	  struct plt_entry **plist;
   6151  1.3  christos 	  unsigned char sym_type;
   6152  1.3  christos 
   6153  1.1  christos 	  switch (r_type)
   6154  1.5  christos 	    {
   6155  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6156  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6157  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6158  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   6159  1.3  christos 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
   6160  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6161  1.1  christos 
   6162  1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6163  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6164  1.8  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6165  1.8  christos 	      max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
   6166  1.8  christos 	      break;
   6167  1.8  christos 
   6168  1.8  christos 	    case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   6169  1.3  christos 	      if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6170  1.8  christos 		break;
   6171  1.8  christos 	      continue;
   6172  1.3  christos 
   6173  1.3  christos 	    default:
   6174  1.3  christos 	      continue;
   6175  1.8  christos 	    }
   6176  1.1  christos 
   6177  1.3  christos 	  /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc.  */
   6178  1.3  christos 	  if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
   6179  1.1  christos 			  ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
   6180  1.3  christos 	    goto error_return;
   6181  1.1  christos 
   6182  1.8  christos 	  if (isym != NULL)
   6183  1.8  christos 	    {
   6184  1.3  christos 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6185  1.3  christos 		;
   6186  1.1  christos 	      else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
   6187  1.8  christos 		tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
   6188  1.8  christos 	      else
   6189  1.8  christos 		continue;
   6190  1.3  christos 
   6191  1.6  christos 	      toff = isym->st_value;
   6192  1.1  christos 	      sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
   6193  1.1  christos 	    }
   6194  1.3  christos 	  else
   6195  1.3  christos 	    {
   6196  1.3  christos 	      if (tsec != NULL)
   6197  1.3  christos 		toff = h->root.u.def.value;
   6198  1.3  christos 	      else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
   6199  1.6  christos 		       || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
   6200  1.3  christos 		{
   6201  1.3  christos 		  unsigned long indx;
   6202  1.1  christos 
   6203  1.3  christos 		  indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   6204  1.3  christos 		  tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
   6205  1.3  christos 		  toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
   6206  1.3  christos 		}
   6207  1.3  christos 	      else
   6208  1.3  christos 		continue;
   6209  1.3  christos 
   6210  1.3  christos 	      /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
   6211  1.3  christos 		 optimise away the call.  We won't be needing a long-
   6212  1.3  christos 		 branch stub in that case.  */
   6213  1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
   6214  1.3  christos 		  && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6215  1.3  christos 		  && irel != internal_relocs)
   6216  1.3  christos 		{
   6217  1.3  christos 		  unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
   6218  1.3  christos 		  unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
   6219  1.3  christos 		  unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
   6220  1.3  christos 
   6221  1.3  christos 		  /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
   6222  1.3  christos 		     R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
   6223  1.3  christos 		     on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn.  Get tls
   6224  1.3  christos 		     mask bits from the symbol on that reloc.  */
   6225  1.3  christos 		  if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   6226  1.3  christos 		    {
   6227  1.3  christos 		      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6228  1.1  christos 
   6229  1.3  christos 		      if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   6230  1.3  christos 			{
   6231  1.3  christos 			  struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6232  1.1  christos 			    (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6233  1.3  christos 			  char *lgot_masks = (char *)
   6234  1.3  christos 			    (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6235  1.3  christos 			  tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
   6236  1.1  christos 			}
   6237  1.3  christos 		    }
   6238  1.3  christos 		  else
   6239  1.3  christos 		    {
   6240  1.3  christos 		      struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
   6241  1.3  christos 			= elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
   6242  1.3  christos 
   6243  1.3  christos 		      while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
   6244  1.3  christos 			     || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
   6245  1.3  christos 			th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
   6246  1.3  christos 
   6247  1.3  christos 		      tls_mask
   6248  1.3  christos 			= ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
   6249  1.3  christos 		    }
   6250  1.1  christos 
   6251  1.3  christos 		  /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
   6252  1.3  christos 		     optimised away.  */
   6253  1.1  christos 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   6254  1.5  christos 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
   6255  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
   6256  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
   6257  1.5  christos 		    continue;
   6258  1.5  christos 		  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   6259  1.5  christos 		      && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
   6260  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
   6261  1.5  christos 			  || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
   6262  1.5  christos 		    continue;
   6263  1.5  christos 		}
   6264  1.5  christos 
   6265  1.3  christos 	      sym_type = h->type;
   6266  1.3  christos 	    }
   6267  1.3  christos 
   6268  1.3  christos 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   6269  1.3  christos 	    {
   6270  1.3  christos 	      if (h != NULL
   6271  1.3  christos 		  && !h->def_regular
   6272  1.3  christos 		  && h->protected_def
   6273  1.3  christos 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   6274  1.3  christos 		  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
   6275  1.3  christos 		picfixup_size += 12;
   6276  1.3  christos 	      continue;
   6277  1.3  christos 	    }
   6278  1.3  christos 
   6279  1.3  christos 	  /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
   6280  1.3  christos 	     match that in relocate_section.  If we call find_plt_ent here
   6281  1.3  christos 	     but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
   6282  1.3  christos 	     destination used here may be incorrect.  */
   6283  1.3  christos 	  plist = NULL;
   6284  1.3  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   6285  1.3  christos 	    {
   6286  1.3  christos 	      /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true.  */
   6287  1.3  christos 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6288  1.3  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6289  1.1  christos 		plist = &h->plt.plist;
   6290  1.6  christos 	    }
   6291  1.3  christos 	  else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
   6292  1.3  christos 		   && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
   6293  1.3  christos 	    {
   6294  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
   6295  1.3  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
   6296  1.3  christos 		(local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   6297  1.3  christos 	      plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
   6298  1.3  christos 	    }
   6299  1.3  christos 	  if (plist != NULL)
   6300  1.3  christos 	    {
   6301  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma addend = 0;
   6302  1.3  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   6303  1.3  christos 
   6304  1.3  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6305  1.7  christos 		addend = irel->r_addend;
   6306  1.3  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
   6307  1.3  christos 	      if (ent != NULL)
   6308  1.3  christos 		{
   6309  1.3  christos 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   6310  1.1  christos 		      || h == NULL
   6311  1.3  christos 		      || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   6312  1.3  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
   6313  1.3  christos 		    {
   6314  1.3  christos 		      tsec = htab->glink;
   6315  1.1  christos 		      toff = ent->glink_offset;
   6316  1.1  christos 		    }
   6317  1.8  christos 		  else
   6318  1.8  christos 		    {
   6319  1.8  christos 		      tsec = htab->elf.splt;
   6320  1.8  christos 		      toff = ent->plt.offset;
   6321  1.8  christos 		    }
   6322  1.8  christos 		}
   6323  1.8  christos 	    }
   6324  1.8  christos 
   6325  1.8  christos 	  /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
   6326  1.8  christos 	     no hope of adding stubs.  We'll error out later should the
   6327  1.8  christos 	     branch overflow.  */
   6328  1.3  christos 	  if (tsec == isec)
   6329  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6330  1.3  christos 
   6331  1.3  christos 	  /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
   6332  1.3  christos 	     undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
   6333  1.3  christos 	     support addends.  It would be possible to do so by
   6334  1.3  christos 	     putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
   6335  1.3  christos 	     branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting.  */
   6336  1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6337  1.3  christos 	      && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
   6338  1.3  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6339  1.3  christos 	      && irel->r_addend != 0)
   6340  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6341  1.3  christos 
   6342  1.3  christos 	  /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
   6343  1.3  christos 	     SEC_MERGE sections;  SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
   6344  1.3  christos 	     attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
   6345  1.3  christos 	     branches.  However, implement it correctly here as a
   6346  1.3  christos 	     reference for other target relax_section functions.  */
   6347  1.3  christos 	  if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
   6348  1.3  christos 	    {
   6349  1.3  christos 	      /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
   6350  1.3  christos 		 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
   6351  1.8  christos 		 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset.  (Later, in
   6352  1.8  christos 		 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
   6353  1.3  christos 		 section symbols have been adjusted.)
   6354  1.3  christos 
   6355  1.3  christos 		 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
   6356  1.3  christos 		 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
   6357  1.3  christos 		 the original addend was zero.  When the reloc is against
   6358  1.3  christos 		 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
   6359  1.1  christos 		 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
   6360  1.8  christos 		 location of interest is the original symbol.  On the
   6361  1.8  christos 		 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
   6362  1.3  christos 		 a section symbol should not include the addend;  Such an
   6363  1.3  christos 		 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym";  The
   6364  1.3  christos 		 location of interest is just "sym".  */
   6365  1.3  christos 	      if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
   6366  1.3  christos 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6367  1.1  christos 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6368  1.3  christos 
   6369  1.6  christos 	      toff
   6370  1.3  christos 		= _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
   6371  1.3  christos 					      elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
   6372  1.3  christos 					      toff);
   6373  1.3  christos 
   6374  1.1  christos 	      if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
   6375  1.1  christos 		  && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6376  1.3  christos 		toff += irel->r_addend;
   6377  1.3  christos 	    }
   6378  1.8  christos 	  /* PLTREL24 addends are special.  */
   6379  1.8  christos 	  else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6380  1.8  christos 	    toff += irel->r_addend;
   6381  1.8  christos 
   6382  1.8  christos 	  /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses.  */
   6383  1.8  christos 	  if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6384  1.8  christos 	       && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
   6385  1.8  christos 	      || tsec->output_section == NULL
   6386  1.8  christos 	      || (tsec->owner != NULL
   6387  1.8  christos 		  && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
   6388  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6389  1.3  christos 
   6390  1.6  christos 	  roff = irel->r_offset;
   6391  1.3  christos 
   6392  1.3  christos 	  /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
   6393  1.3  christos 	     relocatable if the output section size is such that a
   6394  1.3  christos 	     fixup can be created at final link.
   6395  1.3  christos 	     The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
   6396  1.3  christos 	     of other fixups being needed at final link.  */
   6397  1.3  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6398  1.3  christos 	      && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
   6399  1.3  christos 		  < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
   6400  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   6401  1.3  christos 
   6402  1.1  christos 	  /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything.  */
   6403  1.3  christos 	  if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
   6404  1.3  christos 	      && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6405  1.5  christos 		  /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
   6406  1.3  christos 		     final link, so do not presume they remain in range.  */
   6407  1.3  christos 		  || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
   6408  1.3  christos 	    {
   6409  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
   6410  1.1  christos 
   6411  1.3  christos 	      symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
   6412  1.3  christos 	      reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
   6413  1.1  christos 	      if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
   6414  1.3  christos 		  < 2 * max_branch_offset)
   6415  1.3  christos 		continue;
   6416  1.3  christos 	    }
   6417  1.3  christos 
   6418  1.3  christos 	  /* Look for an existing fixup to this address.  */
   6419  1.1  christos 	  for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
   6420  1.6  christos 	    if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
   6421  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6422  1.3  christos 
   6423  1.3  christos 	  if (f == NULL)
   6424  1.3  christos 	    {
   6425  1.3  christos 	      size_t size;
   6426  1.3  christos 	      unsigned long stub_rtype;
   6427  1.3  christos 
   6428  1.3  christos 	      val = trampoff - roff;
   6429  1.3  christos 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6430  1.3  christos 		/* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline.  Don't try to add
   6431  1.7  christos 		   one.  We'll report an error later.  */
   6432  1.3  christos 		continue;
   6433  1.3  christos 
   6434  1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
   6435  1.3  christos 		{
   6436  1.3  christos 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
   6437  1.3  christos 		  insn_offset = 12;
   6438  1.1  christos 		}
   6439  1.3  christos 	      else
   6440  1.3  christos 		{
   6441  1.3  christos 		  size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   6442  1.3  christos 		  insn_offset = 0;
   6443  1.3  christos 		}
   6444  1.3  christos 	      stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
   6445  1.3  christos 	      if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
   6446  1.3  christos 		  || tsec == htab->glink)
   6447  1.3  christos 		{
   6448  1.3  christos 		  stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
   6449  1.3  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
   6450  1.5  christos 		    stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
   6451  1.3  christos 		}
   6452  1.3  christos 
   6453  1.3  christos 	      /* Hijack the old relocation.  Since we need two
   6454  1.5  christos 		 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc.  */
   6455  1.1  christos 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
   6456  1.3  christos 					   stub_rtype);
   6457  1.3  christos 	      irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
   6458  1.3  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   6459  1.1  christos 		  && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   6460  1.1  christos 		irel->r_addend = 0;
   6461  1.3  christos 
   6462  1.3  christos 	      /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section.  */
   6463  1.3  christos 	      f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
   6464  1.3  christos 	      f->next = branch_fixups;
   6465  1.3  christos 	      f->tsec = tsec;
   6466  1.3  christos 	      f->toff = toff;
   6467  1.3  christos 	      f->trampoff = trampoff;
   6468  1.3  christos 	      branch_fixups = f;
   6469  1.3  christos 
   6470  1.3  christos 	      trampoff += size;
   6471  1.3  christos 	      changes++;
   6472  1.3  christos 	    }
   6473  1.3  christos 	  else
   6474  1.3  christos 	    {
   6475  1.1  christos 	      val = f->trampoff - roff;
   6476  1.3  christos 	      if (val >= max_branch_offset)
   6477  1.1  christos 		continue;
   6478  1.1  christos 
   6479  1.1  christos 	      /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here.  */
   6480  1.3  christos 	      irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6481  1.3  christos 	    }
   6482  1.3  christos 
   6483  1.3  christos 	  /* Get the section contents.  */
   6484  1.3  christos 	  if (contents == NULL)
   6485  1.3  christos 	    {
   6486  1.3  christos 	      /* Get cached copy if it exists.  */
   6487  1.3  christos 	      if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
   6488  1.3  christos 		contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
   6489  1.3  christos 	      /* Go get them off disk.  */
   6490  1.3  christos 	      else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
   6491  1.3  christos 		goto error_return;
   6492  1.1  christos 	    }
   6493  1.3  christos 
   6494  1.3  christos 	  /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline.  */
   6495  1.3  christos 	  hit_addr = contents + roff;
   6496  1.3  christos 	  switch (r_type)
   6497  1.3  christos 	    {
   6498  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL24:
   6499  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   6500  1.3  christos 	    case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   6501  1.3  christos 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6502  1.1  christos 	      t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
   6503  1.1  christos 	      t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
   6504  1.5  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6505  1.1  christos 	      break;
   6506  1.5  christos 
   6507  1.5  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14:
   6508  1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   6509  1.1  christos 	    case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   6510  1.3  christos 	      t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
   6511  1.1  christos 	      t0 &= ~0xfffc;
   6512  1.3  christos 	      t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
   6513  1.3  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
   6514  1.3  christos 	      break;
   6515  1.6  christos 	    }
   6516  1.3  christos 	}
   6517  1.3  christos 
   6518  1.3  christos       while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6519  1.3  christos 	{
   6520  1.3  christos 	  struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6521  1.3  christos 	  branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6522  1.3  christos 	  free (f);
   6523  1.3  christos 	}
   6524  1.3  christos     }
   6525  1.3  christos 
   6526  1.3  christos   workaround_change = FALSE;
   6527  1.3  christos   newsize = trampoff;
   6528  1.3  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   6529  1.3  christos       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
   6530  1.3  christos 	  || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
   6531  1.3  christos     {
   6532  1.3  christos       bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
   6533  1.3  christos       unsigned int crossings;
   6534  1.3  christos       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6535  1.3  christos 
   6536  1.3  christos       addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
   6537  1.3  christos       end_addr = addr + trampoff;
   6538  1.3  christos       addr &= -pagesize;
   6539  1.3  christos       crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   6540  1.1  christos       if (crossings != 0)
   6541  1.3  christos 	{
   6542  1.3  christos 	  /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
   6543  1.1  christos 	     not cross a page.  Don't decrease size calculated on a
   6544  1.5  christos 	     previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout.  */
   6545  1.5  christos 	  newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
   6546  1.5  christos 	  newsize += crossings * 16;
   6547  1.5  christos 	  if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
   6548  1.5  christos 	    {
   6549  1.5  christos 	      relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
   6550  1.5  christos 	      workaround_change = TRUE;
   6551  1.5  christos 	    }
   6552  1.5  christos 	  /* Ensure relocate_section is called.  */
   6553  1.3  christos 	  isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
   6554  1.1  christos 	}
   6555  1.1  christos       newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
   6556  1.1  christos     }
   6557  1.1  christos 
   6558  1.1  christos   if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   6559  1.1  christos     {
   6560  1.1  christos       picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6561  1.1  christos       if (picfixup_size != 0)
   6562  1.1  christos 	relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
   6563  1.1  christos       newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
   6564  1.1  christos     }
   6565  1.1  christos 
   6566  1.1  christos   if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
   6567  1.1  christos     isec->size = newsize;
   6568  1.1  christos 
   6569  1.1  christos   if (isymbuf != NULL
   6570  1.1  christos       && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
   6571  1.1  christos     {
   6572  1.1  christos       if (! link_info->keep_memory)
   6573  1.1  christos 	free (isymbuf);
   6574  1.1  christos       else
   6575  1.1  christos 	{
   6576  1.1  christos 	  /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6577  1.1  christos 	  symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
   6578  1.1  christos 	}
   6579  1.5  christos     }
   6580  1.1  christos 
   6581  1.1  christos   if (contents != NULL
   6582  1.1  christos       && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6583  1.1  christos     {
   6584  1.1  christos       if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
   6585  1.1  christos 	free (contents);
   6586  1.1  christos       else
   6587  1.1  christos 	{
   6588  1.1  christos 	  /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd.  */
   6589  1.1  christos 	  elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
   6590  1.1  christos 	}
   6591  1.1  christos     }
   6592  1.1  christos 
   6593  1.1  christos   changes += picfixup_size;
   6594  1.1  christos   if (changes != 0)
   6595  1.1  christos     {
   6596  1.1  christos       /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
   6597  1.1  christos 	 information for the trampolines.  */
   6598  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   6599  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
   6600  1.1  christos 						  * sizeof (*new_relocs));
   6601  1.1  christos       unsigned ix;
   6602  1.1  christos 
   6603  1.1  christos       if (!new_relocs)
   6604  1.1  christos 	goto error_return;
   6605  1.1  christos       memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
   6606  1.9  christos 	      isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
   6607  1.1  christos       for (ix = changes; ix--;)
   6608  1.1  christos 	{
   6609  1.3  christos 	  irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
   6610  1.1  christos 
   6611  1.1  christos 	  irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
   6612  1.1  christos 	}
   6613  1.5  christos       if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
   6614  1.3  christos 	free (internal_relocs);
   6615  1.5  christos       elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
   6616  1.5  christos       isec->reloc_count += changes;
   6617  1.3  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
   6618  1.3  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   6619  1.9  christos     }
   6620  1.1  christos   else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6621  1.9  christos     free (internal_relocs);
   6622  1.1  christos 
   6623  1.9  christos   *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
   6624  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   6625  1.1  christos 
   6626  1.1  christos  error_return:
   6627  1.1  christos   while (branch_fixups != NULL)
   6628  1.1  christos     {
   6629  1.1  christos       struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
   6630  1.1  christos       branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
   6631  1.1  christos       free (f);
   6632  1.1  christos     }
   6633  1.1  christos   if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
   6634  1.1  christos     free (isymbuf);
   6635  1.1  christos   if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
   6636  1.1  christos     free (contents);
   6637  1.1  christos   if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
   6638  1.1  christos     free (internal_relocs);
   6639  1.1  christos   return FALSE;
   6640  1.1  christos }
   6641  1.1  christos 
   6642  1.1  christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
   6644  1.1  christos    discarded sections.  */
   6645  1.1  christos 
   6646  1.1  christos static unsigned int
   6647  1.1  christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
   6648  1.1  christos {
   6649  1.1  christos   if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
   6650  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6651  1.1  christos 
   6652  1.1  christos   if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
   6653  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6654  1.1  christos 
   6655  1.1  christos   return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
   6656  1.1  christos }
   6657  1.1  christos 
   6658  1.1  christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section.  */
   6660  1.1  christos 
   6661  1.1  christos static bfd_vma
   6662  1.1  christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
   6663  1.1  christos 				   elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
   6664  1.1  christos 				   struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   6665  1.1  christos 				   bfd_vma relocation,
   6666  1.1  christos 				   const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
   6667  1.1  christos {
   6668  1.1  christos   elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
   6669  1.1  christos 
   6670  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
   6671  1.1  christos 
   6672  1.1  christos   if (h != NULL)
   6673  1.1  christos     {
   6674  1.1  christos       /* Handle global symbol.  */
   6675  1.1  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
   6676  1.1  christos 
   6677  1.1  christos       eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
   6678  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
   6679  1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
   6680  1.1  christos     }
   6681  1.1  christos   else
   6682  1.1  christos     {
   6683  1.1  christos       /* Handle local symbol.  */
   6684  1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   6685  1.1  christos 
   6686  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
   6687  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
   6688  1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
   6689  1.1  christos     }
   6690  1.1  christos 
   6691  1.1  christos   linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
   6692  1.1  christos 							rel->r_addend,
   6693  1.1  christos 							lsect);
   6694  1.1  christos   BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
   6695  1.1  christos 
   6696  1.1  christos   /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
   6697  1.1  christos      as a "written" flag.  */
   6698  1.1  christos   if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
   6699  1.1  christos     {
   6700  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
   6701  1.1  christos 		  relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
   6702  1.1  christos 		  lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
   6703  1.1  christos       linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
   6704  1.1  christos     }
   6705  1.1  christos 
   6706  1.1  christos   relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
   6707  1.1  christos 		+ lsect->section->output_offset
   6708  1.1  christos 		+ linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
   6709  1.8  christos 		- SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
   6710  1.8  christos 
   6711  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   6712  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr,
   6713  1.1  christos 	   "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
   6714  1.1  christos 	   lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
   6715  1.1  christos #endif
   6716  1.8  christos 
   6717  1.8  christos   return relocation;
   6718  1.8  christos }
   6719  1.8  christos 
   6720  1.8  christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
   6721  1.8  christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
   6722  1.8  christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
   6723  1.8  christos 
   6724  1.8  christos static void
   6725  1.8  christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
   6726  1.8  christos 		  asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
   6727  1.8  christos 		  struct bfd_link_info *info)
   6728  1.8  christos {
   6729  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6730  1.8  christos   bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
   6731  1.8  christos   bfd_vma plt;
   6732  1.8  christos   unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
   6733  1.8  christos 
   6734  1.8  christos   if (h != NULL
   6735  1.8  christos       && h == htab->tls_get_addr
   6736  1.8  christos       && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
   6737  1.8  christos     {
   6738  1.8  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
   6739  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6740  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
   6741  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6742  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
   6743  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6744  1.6  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
   6745  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6746  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
   6747  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6748  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
   6749  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6750  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
   6751  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6752  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   6753  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6754  1.1  christos     }
   6755  1.1  christos 
   6756  1.1  christos   plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
   6757  1.1  christos 	 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
   6758  1.8  christos 	 + plt_sec->output_offset);
   6759  1.1  christos 
   6760  1.1  christos   if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   6761  1.1  christos     {
   6762  1.1  christos       bfd_vma got = 0;
   6763  1.1  christos 
   6764  1.1  christos       if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   6765  1.1  christos 	got = (ent->addend
   6766  1.1  christos 	       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   6767  1.1  christos 	       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   6768  1.1  christos       else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   6769  1.1  christos 	got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   6770  1.1  christos 
   6771  1.8  christos       plt -= got;
   6772  1.8  christos 
   6773  1.8  christos       if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   6774  1.8  christos 	bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6775  1.8  christos       else
   6776  1.8  christos 	{
   6777  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6778  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   6779  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6780  1.1  christos 	}
   6781  1.1  christos     }
   6782  1.1  christos   else
   6783  1.1  christos     {
   6784  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
   6785  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6786  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
   6787  1.1  christos     }
   6788  1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6789  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
   6790  1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6791  1.1  christos   bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   6792  1.1  christos   p += 4;
   6793  1.1  christos   while (p < end)
   6794  1.1  christos     {
   6795  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   6796  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   6797  1.1  christos     }
   6798  1.1  christos }
   6799  1.1  christos 
   6800  1.1  christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically.  */
   6801  1.1  christos 
   6802  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6803  1.1  christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
   6804  1.9  christos {
   6805  1.1  christos   return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   6806  1.1  christos 	   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
   6807  1.1  christos 	  && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
   6808  1.1  christos 	  && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
   6809  1.1  christos }
   6810  1.1  christos 
   6811  1.1  christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
   6812  1.1  christos    the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0.  If
   6813  1.1  christos    REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG.  */
   6814  1.1  christos 
   6815  1.1  christos unsigned int
   6816  1.1  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6817  1.1  christos {
   6818  1.1  christos   unsigned int rtra;
   6819  1.1  christos 
   6820  1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
   6821  1.1  christos     return 0;
   6822  1.9  christos 
   6823  1.1  christos   if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6824  1.1  christos     rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
   6825  1.9  christos   else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
   6826  1.1  christos     rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
   6827  1.1  christos   else
   6828  1.9  christos     return 0;
   6829  1.1  christos 
   6830  1.1  christos   if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
   6831  1.1  christos     /* add -> addi.  */
   6832  1.1  christos     insn = 14 << 26;
   6833  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
   6834  1.1  christos 	   && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
   6835  1.1  christos 	       || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
   6836  1.1  christos 		   && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
   6837  1.1  christos     /* load and store indexed -> dform.  */
   6838  1.1  christos     insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
   6839  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
   6840  1.1  christos     /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu.  */
   6841  1.1  christos     insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
   6842  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
   6843  1.9  christos     /* lwax -> lwa.  */
   6844  1.9  christos     insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
   6845  1.9  christos   else
   6846  1.9  christos     return 0;
   6847  1.9  christos   insn |= rtra;
   6848  1.9  christos   return insn;
   6849  1.9  christos }
   6850  1.9  christos 
   6851  1.9  christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
   6852  1.9  christos    the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
   6853  1.9  christos    thread pointer REG operand removed.  Otherwise return 0.  */
   6854  1.9  christos 
   6855  1.9  christos unsigned int
   6856  1.9  christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
   6857  1.9  christos {
   6858  1.9  christos   if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
   6859  1.1  christos       && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
   6860  1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
   6861  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   6862  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   6863  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   6864  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   6865  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   6866  1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   6867  1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   6868  1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   6869  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   6870  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   6871  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   6872  1.9  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   6873  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   6874  1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   6875  1.1  christos 	      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   6876  1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   6877  1.1  christos 	      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
   6878  1.1  christos     {
   6879  1.1  christos       insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   6880  1.1  christos     }
   6881  1.1  christos   else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
   6882  1.1  christos 	   && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
   6883  1.9  christos 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
   6884  1.9  christos 	       || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
   6885  1.9  christos     {
   6886  1.9  christos       insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
   6887  1.1  christos       insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
   6888  1.1  christos       if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
   6889  1.1  christos 	insn -= 2 >> 26;  /* convert to ori,oris */
   6890  1.1  christos     }
   6891  1.1  christos   else
   6892  1.9  christos     insn = 0;
   6893  1.9  christos   return insn;
   6894  1.6  christos }
   6895  1.1  christos 
   6896  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6897  1.1  christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
   6898  1.1  christos {
   6899  1.1  christos   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
   6900  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
   6901  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
   6902  1.1  christos 	  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
   6903  1.1  christos }
   6904  1.1  christos 
   6905  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6906  1.1  christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
   6907  1.1  christos {
   6908  1.1  christos   return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
   6909  1.1  christos 	  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
   6910  1.1  christos 	      && (insn & 3) == 1));
   6911  1.1  christos }
   6912  1.1  christos 
   6913  1.1  christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
   6914  1.1  christos    to handle the relocations for a section.
   6915  1.1  christos 
   6916  1.1  christos    The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
   6917  1.1  christos    actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
   6918  1.1  christos    zero.
   6919  1.1  christos 
   6920  1.1  christos    This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
   6921  1.1  christos    necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
   6922  1.1  christos    relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
   6923  1.1  christos    necessary.
   6924  1.1  christos 
   6925  1.1  christos    This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
   6926  1.1  christos    address or the reloc symbol index.
   6927  1.1  christos 
   6928  1.1  christos    LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
   6929  1.1  christos 
   6930  1.1  christos    LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
   6931  1.1  christos    corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
   6932  1.1  christos 
   6933  1.1  christos    The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
   6934  1.1  christos    via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
   6935  1.1  christos 
   6936  1.1  christos    When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
   6937  1.1  christos    STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially.  The output symbol is
   6938  1.1  christos    going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
   6939  1.1  christos    section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
   6940  1.6  christos    accordingly.  */
   6941  1.1  christos 
   6942  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   6943  1.1  christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
   6944  1.1  christos 			  struct bfd_link_info *info,
   6945  1.1  christos 			  bfd *input_bfd,
   6946  1.7  christos 			  asection *input_section,
   6947  1.1  christos 			  bfd_byte *contents,
   6948  1.5  christos 			  Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
   6949  1.5  christos 			  Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
   6950  1.1  christos 			  asection **local_sections)
   6951  1.1  christos {
   6952  1.8  christos   Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   6953  1.1  christos   struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
   6954  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   6955  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
   6956  1.6  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
   6957  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
   6958  1.1  christos   Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
   6959  1.8  christos   asection *got2;
   6960  1.8  christos   bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
   6961  1.8  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   6962  1.8  christos   bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
   6963  1.8  christos   bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
   6964  1.8  christos   unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
   6965  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
   6966  1.1  christos 
   6967  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   6968  1.1  christos   _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
   6969  1.1  christos 		      "%ld relocations%s",
   6970  1.1  christos 		      input_bfd, input_section,
   6971  1.1  christos 		      (long) input_section->reloc_count,
   6972  1.1  christos 		      (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
   6973  1.1  christos #endif
   6974  1.1  christos 
   6975  1.1  christos   if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
   6976  1.1  christos     {
   6977  1.9  christos       bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
   6978  1.1  christos       return FALSE;
   6979  1.1  christos     }
   6980  1.5  christos 
   6981  1.5  christos   got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
   6982  1.6  christos 
   6983  1.1  christos   /* Initialize howto table if not already done.  */
   6984  1.6  christos   if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
   6985  1.1  christos     ppc_elf_howto_init ();
   6986  1.1  christos 
   6987  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   6988  1.1  christos   local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
   6989  1.1  christos   symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
   6990  1.1  christos   sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
   6991  1.1  christos   /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
   6992  1.1  christos      specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'.  */
   6993  1.1  christos   is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
   6994  1.1  christos 		    && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
   6995  1.1  christos 				".tls_vars"));
   6996  1.1  christos   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
   6997  1.8  christos     relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
   6998  1.1  christos   rel = wrel = relocs;
   6999  1.1  christos   relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
   7000  1.8  christos   for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
   7001  1.3  christos     {
   7002  1.1  christos       enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   7003  1.6  christos       bfd_vma addend;
   7004  1.1  christos       bfd_reloc_status_type r;
   7005  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   7006  1.1  christos       asection *sec;
   7007  1.1  christos       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
   7008  1.1  christos       const char *sym_name;
   7009  1.1  christos       reloc_howto_type *howto;
   7010  1.1  christos       unsigned long r_symndx;
   7011  1.1  christos       bfd_vma relocation;
   7012  1.1  christos       bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
   7013  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
   7014  1.1  christos       bfd_boolean warned;
   7015  1.1  christos       unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
   7016  1.1  christos       struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
   7017  1.1  christos       struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
   7018  1.1  christos 
   7019  1.1  christos     again:
   7020  1.1  christos       r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
   7021  1.1  christos       sym = NULL;
   7022  1.1  christos       sec = NULL;
   7023  1.1  christos       h = NULL;
   7024  1.1  christos       unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7025  1.1  christos       warned = FALSE;
   7026  1.1  christos       r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
   7027  1.1  christos 
   7028  1.1  christos       if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7029  1.1  christos 	{
   7030  1.1  christos 	  sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
   7031  1.1  christos 	  sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
   7032  1.1  christos 	  sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
   7033  1.1  christos 
   7034  1.1  christos 	  relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
   7035  1.1  christos 	}
   7036  1.1  christos       else
   7037  1.1  christos 	{
   7038  1.1  christos 	  bfd_boolean ignored;
   7039  1.1  christos 
   7040  1.6  christos 	  RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
   7041  1.6  christos 				   r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
   7042  1.8  christos 				   h, sec, relocation,
   7043  1.6  christos 				   unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
   7044  1.6  christos 
   7045  1.6  christos 	  sym_name = h->root.root.string;
   7046  1.6  christos 	}
   7047  1.6  christos 
   7048  1.8  christos       if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
   7049  1.6  christos 	{
   7050  1.6  christos 	  /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
   7051  1.6  christos 	     or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
   7052  1.6  christos 	     section contents zeroed.  Avoid any special processing.  */
   7053  1.6  christos 	  howto = NULL;
   7054  1.6  christos 	  if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7055  1.6  christos 	    howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7056  1.1  christos 
   7057  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
   7058  1.6  christos 			       contents, rel->r_offset);
   7059  1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
   7060  1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_info = 0;
   7061  1.1  christos 	  wrel->r_addend = 0;
   7062  1.1  christos 
   7063  1.1  christos 	  /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
   7064  1.1  christos 	     symbols defined in discarded sections.  Not done for
   7065  1.1  christos 	     non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
   7066  1.1  christos 	     eh_frame editing code expects to be present.  */
   7067  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   7068  1.3  christos 	      && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
   7069  1.3  christos 	    wrel--;
   7070  1.3  christos 
   7071  1.6  christos 	  continue;
   7072  1.1  christos 	}
   7073  1.1  christos 
   7074  1.1  christos       if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   7075  1.1  christos 	{
   7076  1.1  christos 	  if (got2 != NULL
   7077  1.1  christos 	      && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7078  1.1  christos 	      && rel->r_addend != 0)
   7079  1.1  christos 	    {
   7080  1.1  christos 	      /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   7081  1.1  christos 		 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.  */
   7082  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
   7083  1.1  christos 	    }
   7084  1.1  christos 	  if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
   7085  1.1  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
   7086  1.1  christos 	      && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
   7087  1.1  christos 	    goto copy_reloc;
   7088  1.1  christos 	}
   7089  1.1  christos 
   7090  1.1  christos       /* TLS optimizations.  Replace instruction sequences and relocs
   7091  1.1  christos 	 based on information we collected in tls_optimize.  We edit
   7092  1.1  christos 	 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
   7093  1.1  christos 	 for the final instruction stream.  */
   7094  1.1  christos       tls_mask = 0;
   7095  1.1  christos       tls_gd = 0;
   7096  1.1  christos       if (h != NULL)
   7097  1.1  christos 	tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
   7098  1.1  christos       else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   7099  1.1  christos 	{
   7100  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7101  1.1  christos 	  char *lgot_masks;
   7102  1.1  christos 	  local_plt
   7103  1.1  christos 	    = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7104  1.1  christos 	  lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7105  1.1  christos 	  tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
   7106  1.1  christos 	}
   7107  1.1  christos 
   7108  1.1  christos       /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane.  */
   7109  1.1  christos       if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
   7110  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
   7111  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
   7112  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
   7113  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3)    != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
   7114  1.7  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
   7115  1.6  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
   7116  1.1  christos 	  || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
   7117  1.1  christos 	abort ();
   7118  1.7  christos       switch (r_type)
   7119  1.6  christos 	{
   7120  1.1  christos 	default:
   7121  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7122  1.1  christos 
   7123  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7124  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7125  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7126  1.1  christos 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
   7127  1.1  christos 	    {
   7128  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7129  1.1  christos 
   7130  1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7131  1.7  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7132  1.1  christos 	      insn &= 31 << 21;
   7133  1.1  christos 	      insn |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis 0,2,0 */
   7134  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7135  1.7  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7136  1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7137  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7138  1.1  christos 	    }
   7139  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7140  1.1  christos 
   7141  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7142  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7143  1.1  christos 	      && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
   7144  1.1  christos 	    {
   7145  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma insn;
   7146  1.1  christos 
   7147  1.9  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7148  1.1  christos 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
   7149  1.1  christos 	      if (insn == 0)
   7150  1.1  christos 		abort ();
   7151  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7152  1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7153  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7154  1.1  christos 
   7155  1.1  christos 	      /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
   7156  1.1  christos 		 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word.  */
   7157  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7158  1.1  christos 	    }
   7159  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7160  1.1  christos 
   7161  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7162  1.5  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7163  1.7  christos 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
   7164  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
   7165  1.1  christos 	    goto tls_gdld_hi;
   7166  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7167  1.1  christos 
   7168  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7169  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7170  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
   7171  1.1  christos 	    {
   7172  1.9  christos 	    tls_gdld_hi:
   7173  1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7174  1.1  christos 		r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7175  1.1  christos 			  + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7176  1.1  christos 	      else
   7177  1.1  christos 		{
   7178  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
   7179  1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7180  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7181  1.1  christos 		}
   7182  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7183  1.1  christos 	    }
   7184  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7185  1.1  christos 
   7186  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7187  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7188  1.1  christos 	  tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
   7189  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
   7190  1.1  christos 	    goto tls_ldgd_opt;
   7191  1.9  christos 	  break;
   7192  1.1  christos 
   7193  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7194  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7195  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
   7196  1.5  christos 	    {
   7197  1.5  christos 	      unsigned int insn1, insn2;
   7198  1.5  christos 	      bfd_vma offset;
   7199  1.5  christos 
   7200  1.7  christos 	    tls_ldgd_opt:
   7201  1.5  christos 	      offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
   7202  1.1  christos 	      /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
   7203  1.1  christos 		 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
   7204  1.1  christos 		 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
   7205  1.5  christos 		 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
   7206  1.9  christos 		 the current reloc.  Edit both insns.  */
   7207  1.1  christos 	      if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
   7208  1.1  christos 		  && rel + 1 < relend
   7209  1.1  christos 		  && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
   7210  1.1  christos 					      htab->tls_get_addr))
   7211  1.7  christos 		offset = rel[1].r_offset;
   7212  1.1  christos 	      /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
   7213  1.1  christos 		 the destination reg.  It may be something other than
   7214  1.1  christos 		 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
   7215  1.1  christos 		 intervening code.  */
   7216  1.1  christos 	      insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7217  1.1  christos 				  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7218  1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
   7219  1.1  christos 		{
   7220  1.5  christos 		  /* IE */
   7221  1.5  christos 		  insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
   7222  1.1  christos 		  insn1 |= 32u << 26;	/* lwz */
   7223  1.1  christos 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   7224  1.1  christos 		    {
   7225  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7226  1.1  christos 		      insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7227  1.1  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7228  1.1  christos 		    }
   7229  1.1  christos 		  r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
   7230  1.1  christos 			    + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
   7231  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7232  1.1  christos 		}
   7233  1.1  christos 	      else
   7234  1.1  christos 		{
   7235  1.1  christos 		  /* LE */
   7236  1.1  christos 		  insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
   7237  1.1  christos 		  insn1 |= 0x3c020000;	/* addis r,2,0 */
   7238  1.1  christos 		  if (tls_gd == 0)
   7239  1.1  christos 		    {
   7240  1.1  christos 		      /* Was an LD reloc.  */
   7241  1.1  christos 		      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7242  1.1  christos 			   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7243  1.1  christos 			   r_symndx++)
   7244  1.1  christos 			if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7245  1.1  christos 			  break;
   7246  1.7  christos 		      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7247  1.1  christos 			r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7248  1.1  christos 		      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7249  1.7  christos 		      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7250  1.1  christos 			rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7251  1.1  christos 					  + sec->output_offset
   7252  1.1  christos 					  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7253  1.1  christos 		    }
   7254  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
   7255  1.6  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7256  1.1  christos 		  if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   7257  1.1  christos 		    {
   7258  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7259  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
   7260  1.1  christos 		      rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   7261  1.8  christos 		      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7262  1.8  christos 		      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7263  1.1  christos 		    }
   7264  1.1  christos 		}
   7265  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
   7266  1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7267  1.8  christos 	      if (tls_gd == 0)
   7268  1.8  christos 		{
   7269  1.8  christos 		  /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc.  Start over
   7270  1.8  christos 		     in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right.  */
   7271  1.8  christos 		  goto again;
   7272  1.8  christos 		}
   7273  1.8  christos 	    }
   7274  1.9  christos 	  break;
   7275  1.1  christos 
   7276  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7277  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
   7278  1.1  christos 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
   7279  1.1  christos 	    {
   7280  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7281  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
   7282  1.1  christos 
   7283  1.1  christos 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7284  1.1  christos 		{
   7285  1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
   7286  1.1  christos 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7287  1.1  christos 		  break;
   7288  1.7  christos 		}
   7289  1.1  christos 
   7290  1.1  christos 	      if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
   7291  1.1  christos 		{
   7292  1.1  christos 		  /* IE */
   7293  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   7294  1.1  christos 		  insn2 = 0x7c631214;	/* add 3,3,2 */
   7295  1.1  christos 		}
   7296  1.8  christos 	      else
   7297  1.8  christos 		{
   7298  1.1  christos 		  /* LE */
   7299  1.1  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
   7300  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7301  1.8  christos 		  insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7302  1.8  christos 		}
   7303  1.8  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
   7304  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
   7305  1.8  christos 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7306  1.8  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7307  1.8  christos 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7308  1.1  christos 	    }
   7309  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7310  1.1  christos 
   7311  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7312  1.1  christos 	  if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
   7313  1.1  christos 	      && rel + 1 < relend)
   7314  1.1  christos 	    {
   7315  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn2;
   7316  1.1  christos 
   7317  1.1  christos 	      if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
   7318  1.1  christos 		{
   7319  1.1  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7320  1.1  christos 		  rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7321  1.1  christos 		  break;
   7322  1.1  christos 		}
   7323  1.1  christos 
   7324  1.7  christos 	      for (r_symndx = 0;
   7325  1.1  christos 		   r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   7326  1.1  christos 		   r_symndx++)
   7327  1.1  christos 		if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
   7328  1.1  christos 		  break;
   7329  1.6  christos 	      if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
   7330  1.1  christos 		r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
   7331  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7332  1.1  christos 	      if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
   7333  1.1  christos 		rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
   7334  1.1  christos 				  + sec->output_offset
   7335  1.1  christos 				  + sec->output_section->vma);
   7336  1.1  christos 
   7337  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
   7338  1.1  christos 	      rel->r_offset += d_offset;
   7339  1.1  christos 	      insn2 = 0x38630000;	/* addi 3,3,0 */
   7340  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
   7341  1.1  christos 			  contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7342  1.1  christos 	      /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too.  */
   7343  1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
   7344  1.1  christos 	      rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
   7345  1.7  christos 	      goto again;
   7346  1.1  christos 	    }
   7347  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7348  1.1  christos 	}
   7349  1.1  christos 
   7350  1.1  christos       /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn.  */
   7351  1.8  christos       branch_bit = 0;
   7352  1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   7353  1.7  christos 	{
   7354  1.1  christos 	default:
   7355  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7356  1.1  christos 
   7357  1.1  christos 	  /* Branch taken prediction relocations.  */
   7358  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   7359  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   7360  1.1  christos 	  branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7361  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   7362  1.1  christos 
   7363  1.1  christos 	  /* Branch not taken prediction relocations.  */
   7364  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   7365  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   7366  1.1  christos 	  {
   7367  1.8  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   7368  1.8  christos 
   7369  1.8  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7370  1.8  christos 	    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7371  1.8  christos 	    insn |= branch_bit;
   7372  1.8  christos 
   7373  1.8  christos 	    from = (rel->r_offset
   7374  1.8  christos 		    + input_section->output_offset
   7375  1.9  christos 		    + input_section->output_section->vma);
   7376  1.8  christos 
   7377  1.8  christos 	    /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default.  */
   7378  1.8  christos 	    if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
   7379  1.8  christos 	      insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   7380  1.8  christos 
   7381  1.8  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   7382  1.8  christos 	  }
   7383  1.8  christos 	  break;
   7384  1.8  christos 
   7385  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   7386  1.8  christos 	  {
   7387  1.8  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   7388  1.8  christos 
   7389  1.8  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7390  1.8  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7391  1.8  christos 	    if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
   7392  1.8  christos 		&& (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
   7393  1.1  christos 	      {
   7394  1.1  christos 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   7395  1.5  christos 		  {
   7396  1.5  christos 		    /* Convert addis to lis.  */
   7397  1.5  christos 		    insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   7398  1.5  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
   7399  1.5  christos 				contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7400  1.5  christos 		  }
   7401  1.5  christos 	      }
   7402  1.5  christos 	    else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   7403  1.5  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   7404  1.5  christos 		(_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
   7405  1.5  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7406  1.5  christos 		 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
   7407  1.5  christos 	  }
   7408  1.5  christos 	  break;
   7409  1.7  christos 	}
   7410  1.5  christos 
   7411  1.9  christos       if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
   7412  1.5  christos 	  && h != NULL
   7413  1.5  christos 	  && !h->def_regular
   7414  1.5  christos 	  && h->protected_def
   7415  1.5  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
   7416  1.5  christos 	  && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
   7417  1.5  christos 	  && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
   7418  1.5  christos 	{
   7419  1.5  christos 	  /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
   7420  1.5  christos 	     variable defined in a shared library to PIC.  */
   7421  1.5  christos 	  unsigned int insn;
   7422  1.5  christos 
   7423  1.5  christos 	  if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
   7424  1.5  christos 	    {
   7425  1.7  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7426  1.5  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7427  1.5  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
   7428  1.7  christos 		  && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
   7429  1.5  christos 		{
   7430  1.7  christos 		  bfd_byte *p;
   7431  1.7  christos 		  bfd_vma off;
   7432  1.5  christos 		  bfd_vma got_addr;
   7433  1.6  christos 
   7434  1.6  christos 		  p = (contents + input_section->size
   7435  1.6  christos 		       - relax_info->workaround_size
   7436  1.5  christos 		       - relax_info->picfixup_size
   7437  1.7  christos 		       + picfixup_size);
   7438  1.7  christos 		  off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7439  1.5  christos 		  if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
   7440  1.5  christos 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7441  1.5  christos 		      (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
   7442  1.5  christos 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   7443  1.5  christos 
   7444  1.5  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
   7445  1.7  christos 			      contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7446  1.5  christos 		  got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7447  1.7  christos 			      + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7448  1.5  christos 			      + (h->got.offset & ~1));
   7449  1.5  christos 		  wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
   7450  1.5  christos 		  wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   7451  1.5  christos 		  wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
   7452  1.5  christos 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7453  1.6  christos 		  insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   7454  1.6  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   7455  1.5  christos 
   7456  1.6  christos 		  /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT.  */
   7457  1.5  christos 		  insn &= ~0xffff;
   7458  1.5  christos 		  insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
   7459  1.5  christos 		  insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
   7460  1.5  christos 		  insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
   7461  1.5  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
   7462  1.5  christos 
   7463  1.8  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
   7464  1.7  christos 		  picfixup_size += 12;
   7465  1.8  christos 
   7466  1.8  christos 		  /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
   7467  1.8  christos 		     output is reasonable.  */
   7468  1.5  christos 		  memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
   7469  1.5  christos 		  wrel++, rel++;
   7470  1.5  christos 		  rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
   7471  1.5  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   7472  1.7  christos 		  rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
   7473  1.5  christos 
   7474  1.9  christos 		  /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
   7475  1.9  christos 		     dynamic reloc.  */
   7476  1.9  christos 		  r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
   7477  1.9  christos 		}
   7478  1.9  christos 	      else
   7479  1.9  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   7480  1.9  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7481  1.9  christos 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7482  1.9  christos 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7483  1.9  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7484  1.9  christos 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
   7485  1.9  christos 	    }
   7486  1.9  christos 	  else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
   7487  1.9  christos 	    {
   7488  1.9  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   7489  1.5  christos 				 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   7490  1.9  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26    /* addi */
   7491  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
   7492  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
   7493  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
   7494  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
   7495  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
   7496  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
   7497  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
   7498  1.5  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
   7499  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
   7500  1.7  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
   7501  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
   7502  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
   7503  1.8  christos 		  || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
   7504  1.5  christos 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
   7505  1.5  christos 		      && (insn & 3) != 1)
   7506  1.5  christos 		  || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
   7507  1.5  christos 		      && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
   7508  1.1  christos 		{
   7509  1.9  christos 		  /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any.  */
   7510  1.1  christos 		  relocation = 0;
   7511  1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7512  1.1  christos 		  rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
   7513  1.1  christos 		}
   7514  1.1  christos 	      else
   7515  1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   7516  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7517  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
   7518  1.1  christos 		     "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
   7519  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
   7520  1.1  christos 		   "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
   7521  1.1  christos 	    }
   7522  1.1  christos 	}
   7523  1.1  christos 
   7524  1.1  christos       ifunc = NULL;
   7525  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
   7526  1.1  christos 	{
   7527  1.1  christos 	  struct plt_entry *ent;
   7528  1.1  christos 
   7529  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   7530  1.6  christos 	    {
   7531  1.8  christos 	      if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7532  1.8  christos 		ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
   7533  1.8  christos 	    }
   7534  1.8  christos 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
   7535  1.1  christos 		   && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   7536  1.1  christos 	    {
   7537  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   7538  1.8  christos 
   7539  1.8  christos 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   7540  1.8  christos 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   7541  1.8  christos 	      ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
   7542  1.1  christos 	    }
   7543  1.1  christos 
   7544  1.1  christos 	  ent = NULL;
   7545  1.1  christos 	  if (ifunc != NULL
   7546  1.1  christos 	      && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
   7547  1.7  christos 		  || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
   7548  1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7549  1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7550  1.7  christos 		  || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7551  1.7  christos 	    {
   7552  1.7  christos 	      addend = 0;
   7553  1.7  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7554  1.7  christos 		  && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
   7555  1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
   7556  1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
   7557  1.7  christos 		      || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
   7558  1.7  christos 		addend = rel->r_addend;
   7559  1.7  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
   7560  1.7  christos 	    }
   7561  1.7  christos 	  if (ent != NULL)
   7562  1.7  christos 	    {
   7563  1.7  christos 	      if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7564  1.7  christos 		  && ent->sec != got2
   7565  1.7  christos 		  && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
   7566  1.7  christos 		  && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7567  1.7  christos 		      || h == NULL
   7568  1.1  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1))
   7569  1.1  christos 		{
   7570  1.1  christos 		  /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
   7571  1.1  christos 		     for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
   7572  1.3  christos 		     finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
   7573  1.3  christos 		     apparently are using code compiled with
   7574  1.1  christos 		     -mbss-plt.  The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
   7575  1.1  christos 		     gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
   7576  1.1  christos 		     whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
   7577  1.1  christos 		     is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
   7578  1.7  christos 		     into .got2).  */
   7579  1.7  christos 		    info->callbacks->einfo
   7580  1.1  christos 		      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7581  1.1  christos 		      (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
   7582  1.1  christos 		       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
   7583  1.1  christos 		}
   7584  1.1  christos 
   7585  1.8  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7586  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   7587  1.1  christos 		  || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7588  1.1  christos 		  || h == NULL
   7589  1.8  christos 		  || h->dynindx == -1)
   7590  1.8  christos 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   7591  1.1  christos 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   7592  1.1  christos 			      + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
   7593  1.1  christos 	      else
   7594  1.8  christos 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   7595  1.8  christos 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   7596  1.8  christos 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   7597  1.1  christos 	    }
   7598  1.1  christos 	}
   7599  1.1  christos 
   7600  1.6  christos       addend = rel->r_addend;
   7601  1.1  christos       save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
   7602  1.1  christos       howto = NULL;
   7603  1.1  christos       if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
   7604  1.1  christos 	howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   7605  1.1  christos 
   7606  1.1  christos       tls_type = 0;
   7607  1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   7608  1.1  christos 	{
   7609  1.6  christos 	default:
   7610  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   7611  1.1  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   7612  1.1  christos 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
   7613  1.1  christos 
   7614  1.1  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   7615  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   7616  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7617  1.1  christos 
   7618  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_NONE:
   7619  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLS:
   7620  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSGD:
   7621  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TLSLD:
   7622  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
   7623  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
   7624  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
   7625  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   7626  1.1  christos 
   7627  1.1  christos 	  /* GOT16 relocations.  Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
   7628  1.1  christos 	     address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
   7629  1.1  christos 	     symbol's value itself.  Also, create a GOT entry for the
   7630  1.1  christos 	     symbol and put the symbol value there.  */
   7631  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   7632  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   7633  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
   7634  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   7635  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7636  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7637  1.1  christos 
   7638  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   7639  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   7640  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
   7641  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   7642  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7643  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7644  1.1  christos 
   7645  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   7646  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   7647  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
   7648  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   7649  1.1  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7650  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7651  1.1  christos 
   7652  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   7653  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   7654  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
   7655  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   7656  1.7  christos 	  tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7657  1.1  christos 	  goto dogot;
   7658  1.1  christos 
   7659  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   7660  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   7661  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
   7662  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   7663  1.1  christos 	  tls_mask = 0;
   7664  1.1  christos 	dogot:
   7665  1.7  christos 	  {
   7666  1.7  christos 	    /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
   7667  1.7  christos 	       offset table.  */
   7668  1.8  christos 	    bfd_vma off;
   7669  1.1  christos 	    bfd_vma *offp;
   7670  1.1  christos 	    unsigned long indx;
   7671  1.1  christos 
   7672  1.1  christos 	    if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
   7673  1.1  christos 	      abort ();
   7674  1.1  christos 
   7675  1.1  christos 	    indx = 0;
   7676  1.1  christos 	    if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
   7677  1.1  christos 		&& SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7678  1.1  christos 	      offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
   7679  1.1  christos 	    else if (h != NULL)
   7680  1.1  christos 	      {
   7681  1.1  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   7682  1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1
   7683  1.1  christos 		    || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
   7684  1.1  christos 		    || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7685  1.1  christos 		  /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
   7686  1.1  christos 		     -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
   7687  1.1  christos 		     locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
   7688  1.1  christos 		     because of a version file.  */
   7689  1.1  christos 		  ;
   7690  1.1  christos 		else
   7691  1.1  christos 		  {
   7692  1.1  christos 		    indx = h->dynindx;
   7693  1.1  christos 		    unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   7694  1.1  christos 		  }
   7695  1.1  christos 		offp = &h->got.offset;
   7696  1.8  christos 	      }
   7697  1.8  christos 	    else
   7698  1.9  christos 	      {
   7699  1.8  christos 		if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
   7700  1.1  christos 		  abort ();
   7701  1.1  christos 		offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
   7702  1.1  christos 	      }
   7703  1.9  christos 
   7704  1.9  christos 	    /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4.  We use the
   7705  1.1  christos 	       least significant bit to record whether we have already
   7706  1.1  christos 	       processed this entry.  */
   7707  1.1  christos 	    off = *offp;
   7708  1.1  christos 	    if ((off & 1) != 0)
   7709  1.1  christos 	      off &= ~1;
   7710  1.1  christos 	    else
   7711  1.1  christos 	      {
   7712  1.1  christos 		unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
   7713  1.1  christos 				      ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
   7714  1.1  christos 						    | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
   7715  1.1  christos 				      : 0);
   7716  1.1  christos 
   7717  1.1  christos 		if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
   7718  1.1  christos 		  tls_m = TLS_LD;
   7719  1.1  christos 		else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
   7720  1.1  christos 			 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7721  1.1  christos 		  tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7722  1.1  christos 
   7723  1.1  christos 		/* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
   7724  1.1  christos 		   Initialize them all.  */
   7725  1.1  christos 		do
   7726  1.1  christos 		  {
   7727  1.1  christos 		    int tls_ty = 0;
   7728  1.9  christos 
   7729  1.1  christos 		    if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
   7730  1.1  christos 		      {
   7731  1.1  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
   7732  1.1  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
   7733  1.1  christos 		      }
   7734  1.1  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7735  1.7  christos 		      {
   7736  1.7  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
   7737  1.7  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
   7738  1.9  christos 		      }
   7739  1.9  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7740  1.8  christos 		      {
   7741  1.8  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
   7742  1.1  christos 			tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
   7743  1.7  christos 		      }
   7744  1.1  christos 		    else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
   7745  1.1  christos 		      {
   7746  1.1  christos 			tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
   7747  1.7  christos 			tls_m = 0;
   7748  1.7  christos 		      }
   7749  1.7  christos 
   7750  1.7  christos 		    /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker.  */
   7751  1.7  christos 		    if (indx != 0
   7752  1.7  christos 			|| (bfd_link_pic (info)
   7753  1.7  christos 			    && (h == NULL
   7754  1.7  christos 				|| !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
   7755  1.7  christos 			    && !(tls_ty != 0
   7756  1.1  christos 				 && bfd_link_executable (info)
   7757  1.1  christos 				 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
   7758  1.1  christos 		      {
   7759  1.1  christos 			asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
   7760  1.1  christos 			bfd_byte * loc;
   7761  1.1  christos 
   7762  1.1  christos 			if (ifunc != NULL)
   7763  1.1  christos 			  {
   7764  1.1  christos 			    rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
   7765  1.1  christos 			    if (indx == 0)
   7766  1.1  christos 			      htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7767  1.1  christos 			    else if (is_static_defined (h))
   7768  1.1  christos 			      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   7769  1.1  christos 			  }
   7770  1.1  christos 			outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7771  1.1  christos 					   + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7772  1.1  christos 					   + off);
   7773  1.1  christos 			outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7774  1.1  christos 			if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7775  1.1  christos 			  {
   7776  1.1  christos 			    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
   7777  1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7778  1.1  christos 			      {
   7779  1.1  christos 				loc = rsec->contents;
   7780  1.1  christos 				loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
   7781  1.1  christos 					* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   7782  1.1  christos 				bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
   7783  1.1  christos 							   &outrel, loc);
   7784  1.1  christos 				outrel.r_offset += 4;
   7785  1.1  christos 				outrel.r_info
   7786  1.1  christos 				  = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7787  1.5  christos 			      }
   7788  1.5  christos 			  }
   7789  1.5  christos 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7790  1.5  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
   7791  1.5  christos 			else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
   7792  1.5  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
   7793  1.1  christos 			else if (indx != 0)
   7794  1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
   7795  1.1  christos 			else if (ifunc != NULL)
   7796  1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   7797  1.1  christos 			else
   7798  1.1  christos 			  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   7799  1.1  christos 			if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7800  1.1  christos 			  {
   7801  1.1  christos 			    outrel.r_addend += relocation;
   7802  1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
   7803  1.1  christos 			      {
   7804  1.1  christos 				if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7805  1.1  christos 				  outrel.r_addend = 0;
   7806  1.7  christos 				else
   7807  1.1  christos 				  outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
   7808  1.5  christos 			      }
   7809  1.5  christos 			  }
   7810  1.5  christos 			loc = rsec->contents;
   7811  1.5  christos 			loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
   7812  1.7  christos 				* sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   7813  1.7  christos 			bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
   7814  1.7  christos 		      }
   7815  1.7  christos 
   7816  1.8  christos 		    /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
   7817  1.5  christos 		       emitting a reloc.  */
   7818  1.5  christos 		    else
   7819  1.1  christos 		      {
   7820  1.7  christos 			bfd_vma value = relocation;
   7821  1.1  christos 
   7822  1.7  christos 			if (tls_ty != 0)
   7823  1.7  christos 			  {
   7824  1.8  christos 			    if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
   7825  1.1  christos 			      value = 0;
   7826  1.1  christos 			    else
   7827  1.7  christos 			      {
   7828  1.7  christos 				if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
   7829  1.1  christos 				  value = 0;
   7830  1.1  christos 				else
   7831  1.1  christos 				  value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7832  1.1  christos 				if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
   7833  1.1  christos 				  value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
   7834  1.1  christos 			      }
   7835  1.1  christos 
   7836  1.1  christos 			    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7837  1.1  christos 			      {
   7838  1.1  christos 				bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7839  1.1  christos 					    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
   7840  1.1  christos 				value = 1;
   7841  1.1  christos 			      }
   7842  1.1  christos 			  }
   7843  1.1  christos 			bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
   7844  1.1  christos 				    htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
   7845  1.1  christos 		      }
   7846  1.1  christos 
   7847  1.1  christos 		    off += 4;
   7848  1.1  christos 		    if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
   7849  1.9  christos 		      off += 4;
   7850  1.1  christos 		  }
   7851  1.1  christos 		while (tls_m != 0);
   7852  1.1  christos 
   7853  1.1  christos 		off = *offp;
   7854  1.1  christos 		*offp = off | 1;
   7855  1.1  christos 	      }
   7856  1.1  christos 
   7857  1.1  christos 	    if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
   7858  1.1  christos 	      abort ();
   7859  1.1  christos 
   7860  1.1  christos 	    if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
   7861  1.1  christos 	      {
   7862  1.1  christos 		if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
   7863  1.1  christos 		  {
   7864  1.5  christos 		    if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
   7865  1.5  christos 			&& !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   7866  1.6  christos 		      off += 8;
   7867  1.5  christos 		    if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
   7868  1.7  christos 		      {
   7869  1.7  christos 			if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
   7870  1.1  christos 			  off += 8;
   7871  1.1  christos 			if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
   7872  1.1  christos 			  {
   7873  1.1  christos 			    if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
   7874  1.1  christos 			      off += 4;
   7875  1.1  christos 			  }
   7876  1.1  christos 		      }
   7877  1.1  christos 		  }
   7878  1.1  christos 	      }
   7879  1.7  christos 
   7880  1.7  christos 	    /* If here for a picfixup, we're done.  */
   7881  1.1  christos 	    if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   7882  1.1  christos 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7883  1.1  christos 
   7884  1.1  christos 	    relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
   7885  1.3  christos 			  + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
   7886  1.1  christos 			  + off
   7887  1.3  christos 			  - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
   7888  1.1  christos 
   7889  1.1  christos 	    /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
   7890  1.1  christos 	       x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
   7891  1.1  christos 	       generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
   7892  1.1  christos 	       got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m.  */
   7893  1.6  christos 	    if (addend != 0)
   7894  1.6  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   7895  1.6  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   7896  1.6  christos 		(_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
   7897  1.6  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7898  1.6  christos 		 howto->name,
   7899  1.6  christos 		 sym_name);
   7900  1.1  christos 	  }
   7901  1.7  christos 	  break;
   7902  1.7  christos 
   7903  1.7  christos 	  /* Relocations that need no special processing.  */
   7904  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
   7905  1.7  christos 	  /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
   7906  1.7  christos 	     at a symbol not in this object.  */
   7907  1.7  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   7908  1.7  christos 	    {
   7909  1.7  christos 	      (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
   7910  1.7  christos 						    h->root.root.string,
   7911  1.7  christos 						    input_bfd,
   7912  1.7  christos 						    input_section,
   7913  1.7  christos 						    rel->r_offset,
   7914  1.7  christos 						    TRUE);
   7915  1.7  christos 	      goto copy_reloc;
   7916  1.1  christos 	    }
   7917  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
   7918  1.1  christos 	    {
   7919  1.1  christos 	      /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
   7920  1.1  christos 		 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere.  More
   7921  1.1  christos 		 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
   7922  1.5  christos 		 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
   7923  1.5  christos 		 access the PLT.  The problem is that a call that is
   7924  1.1  christos 		 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
   7925  1.1  christos 		 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
   7926  1.1  christos 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section.  */
   7927  1.1  christos 	      /* xgettext:c-format */
   7928  1.1  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
   7929  1.1  christos 				      input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   7930  1.1  christos 				      h->root.root.string);
   7931  1.1  christos 	    }
   7932  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7933  1.1  christos 
   7934  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   7935  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   7936  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
   7937  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   7938  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   7939  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7940  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7941  1.7  christos 
   7942  1.1  christos 	  /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
   7943  1.1  christos 	     object.  */
   7944  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   7945  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   7946  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
   7947  1.5  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   7948  1.5  christos 	  if (h != NULL
   7949  1.1  christos 	      && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   7950  1.8  christos 	      && h->dynindx == -1)
   7951  1.8  christos 	    {
   7952  1.1  christos 	      /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
   7953  1.1  christos 		 resolve to zero.  This is really just a tweak, since
   7954  1.1  christos 		 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
   7955  1.5  christos 		 defined before using them.  */
   7956  1.5  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
   7957  1.1  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   7958  1.1  christos 	      insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
   7959  1.1  christos 	      if (insn != 0)
   7960  1.5  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   7961  1.5  christos 	      break;
   7962  1.1  christos 	    }
   7963  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   7964  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   7965  1.1  christos 	  /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
   7966  1.1  christos 	     libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
   7967  1.1  christos 	     DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway.  */
   7968  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   7969  1.1  christos 
   7970  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL32:
   7971  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   7972  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
   7973  1.6  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   7974  1.1  christos 
   7975  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
   7976  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
   7977  1.1  christos 	    addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
   7978  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   7979  1.1  christos 
   7980  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
   7981  1.1  christos 	  relocation = 1;
   7982  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   7983  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   7984  1.1  christos 
   7985  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16:
   7986  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   7987  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   7988  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   7989  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   7990  1.1  christos 	  break;
   7991  1.1  christos 
   7992  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL32:
   7993  1.1  christos 	  if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   7994  1.1  christos 	    break;
   7995  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   7996  1.1  christos 
   7997  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   7998  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   7999  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8000  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
   8001  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8002  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   8003  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_UADDR16:
   8004  1.1  christos 	  goto dodyn;
   8005  1.1  christos 
   8006  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
   8007  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
   8008  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
   8009  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL24:
   8010  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14:
   8011  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
   8012  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
   8013  1.1  christos 	  /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
   8014  1.1  christos 	     handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker.  */
   8015  1.1  christos 	  if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
   8016  1.1  christos 	      || h == htab->elf.hgot)
   8017  1.8  christos 	    break;
   8018  1.8  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8019  1.9  christos 
   8020  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR24:
   8021  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14:
   8022  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
   8023  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
   8024  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
   8025  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8026  1.1  christos 	  /* fall through */
   8027  1.1  christos 
   8028  1.7  christos 	dodyn:
   8029  1.7  christos 	  if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
   8030  1.1  christos 	      || is_vxworks_tls)
   8031  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8032  1.1  christos 
   8033  1.1  christos 	  if (bfd_link_pic (info)
   8034  1.1  christos 	      ? ((h == NULL
   8035  1.1  christos 		  || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
   8036  1.1  christos 		 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
   8037  1.1  christos 		     || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
   8038  1.1  christos 	      : (h != NULL
   8039  1.1  christos 		 && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
   8040  1.1  christos 	    {
   8041  1.1  christos 	      int skip;
   8042  1.1  christos 	      bfd_byte *loc;
   8043  1.1  christos 	      asection *sreloc;
   8044  1.1  christos 	      long indx = 0;
   8045  1.1  christos 
   8046  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   8047  1.1  christos 	      fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
   8048  1.1  christos 		       "create relocation for %s\n",
   8049  1.1  christos 		       (h && h->root.root.string
   8050  1.9  christos 			? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
   8051  1.9  christos #endif
   8052  1.9  christos 
   8053  1.9  christos 	      /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
   8054  1.9  christos 		 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
   8055  1.9  christos 		 time.  */
   8056  1.9  christos 	      skip = 0;
   8057  1.9  christos 	      outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
   8058  1.1  christos 							 input_section,
   8059  1.1  christos 							 rel->r_offset);
   8060  1.8  christos 	      if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
   8061  1.1  christos 		  || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
   8062  1.7  christos 		skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
   8063  1.7  christos 	      outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
   8064  1.1  christos 				  + input_section->output_offset);
   8065  1.7  christos 
   8066  1.1  christos 	      /* Optimize unaligned reloc use.  */
   8067  1.1  christos 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
   8068  1.1  christos 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
   8069  1.1  christos 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
   8070  1.1  christos 	      if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
   8071  1.1  christos 		  || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
   8072  1.1  christos 		r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
   8073  1.1  christos 
   8074  1.1  christos 	      if (skip)
   8075  1.1  christos 		memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
   8076  1.1  christos 	      else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
   8077  1.1  christos 		{
   8078  1.1  christos 		  indx = h->dynindx;
   8079  1.1  christos 		  BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
   8080  1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8081  1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8082  1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8083  1.1  christos 		}
   8084  1.1  christos 	      else
   8085  1.1  christos 		{
   8086  1.1  christos 		  outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
   8087  1.1  christos 
   8088  1.1  christos 		  if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
   8089  1.7  christos 		    {
   8090  1.7  christos 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8091  1.1  christos 			{
   8092  1.1  christos 			  /* If we get here when building a static
   8093  1.1  christos 			     executable, then the libc startup function
   8094  1.1  christos 			     responsible for applying indirect function
   8095  1.1  christos 			     relocations is going to complain about
   8096  1.1  christos 			     the reloc type.
   8097  1.1  christos 			     If we get here when building a dynamic
   8098  1.1  christos 			     executable, it will be because we have
   8099  1.1  christos 			     a text relocation.  The dynamic loader
   8100  1.1  christos 			     will set the text segment writable and
   8101  1.1  christos 			     non-executable to apply text relocations.
   8102  1.1  christos 			     So we'll segfault when trying to run the
   8103  1.1  christos 			     indirection function to resolve the reloc.  */
   8104  1.1  christos 			  info->callbacks->einfo
   8105  1.1  christos 			    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8106  1.1  christos 			    (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
   8107  1.1  christos 			       "function %s unsupported\n"),
   8108  1.1  christos 			     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8109  1.1  christos 			     howto->name,
   8110  1.1  christos 			     sym_name);
   8111  1.1  christos 			  ret = FALSE;
   8112  1.1  christos 			}
   8113  1.1  christos 		      else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
   8114  1.1  christos 			;
   8115  1.9  christos 		      else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
   8116  1.9  christos 			{
   8117  1.9  christos 			  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8118  1.9  christos 			  ret = FALSE;
   8119  1.9  christos 			}
   8120  1.9  christos 		      else
   8121  1.1  christos 			{
   8122  1.1  christos 			  asection *osec;
   8123  1.9  christos 
   8124  1.9  christos 			  /* We are turning this relocation into one
   8125  1.9  christos 			     against a section symbol.  It would be
   8126  1.9  christos 			     proper to subtract the symbol's value,
   8127  1.9  christos 			     osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
   8128  1.9  christos 			     but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
   8129  1.1  christos 			     FIXME: Why not always use a zero index?  */
   8130  1.9  christos 			  osec = sec->output_section;
   8131  1.9  christos 			  if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
   8132  1.9  christos 			    {
   8133  1.9  christos 			      osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
   8134  1.9  christos 			      indx = 0;
   8135  1.9  christos 			    }
   8136  1.1  christos 			  else
   8137  1.1  christos 			    {
   8138  1.1  christos 			      indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8139  1.1  christos 			      if (indx == 0)
   8140  1.1  christos 				{
   8141  1.1  christos 				  osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
   8142  1.1  christos 				  indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
   8143  1.1  christos 				}
   8144  1.1  christos 			      BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
   8145  1.1  christos 			    }
   8146  1.7  christos 
   8147  1.7  christos 			  /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
   8148  1.7  christos 			     Don't leave the symbol value in the
   8149  1.7  christos 			     addend for them.  */
   8150  1.7  christos 			  if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
   8151  1.7  christos 			    outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
   8152  1.7  christos 			}
   8153  1.7  christos 
   8154  1.7  christos 		      outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
   8155  1.7  christos 		    }
   8156  1.7  christos 		  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8157  1.7  christos 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   8158  1.1  christos 		  else
   8159  1.1  christos 		    outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   8160  1.1  christos 		}
   8161  1.1  christos 
   8162  1.1  christos 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   8163  1.6  christos 	      if (ifunc)
   8164  1.1  christos 		{
   8165  1.7  christos 		  sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
   8166  1.7  christos 		  if (indx == 0)
   8167  1.7  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8168  1.1  christos 		  else if (is_static_defined (h))
   8169  1.1  christos 		    htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   8170  1.1  christos 		}
   8171  1.1  christos 	      if (sreloc == NULL)
   8172  1.1  christos 		return FALSE;
   8173  1.1  christos 
   8174  1.1  christos 	      loc = sreloc->contents;
   8175  1.1  christos 	      loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   8176  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
   8177  1.1  christos 
   8178  1.1  christos 	      if (skip == -1)
   8179  1.1  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8180  1.1  christos 
   8181  1.1  christos 	      /* This reloc will be computed at runtime.  Clear the memory
   8182  1.1  christos 		 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink.  */
   8183  1.1  christos 	      if (!skip)
   8184  1.1  christos 		{
   8185  1.6  christos 		  relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
   8186  1.1  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8187  1.1  christos 		  break;
   8188  1.1  christos 		}
   8189  1.1  christos 	    }
   8190  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8191  1.1  christos 
   8192  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
   8193  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
   8194  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   8195  1.7  christos 	    {
   8196  1.7  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8197  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
   8198  1.1  christos 
   8199  1.7  christos 	      if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
   8200  1.1  christos 		{
   8201  1.1  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8202  1.1  christos 		    got2_addend = addend;
   8203  1.3  christos 		  addend = 0;
   8204  1.3  christos 		}
   8205  1.3  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
   8206  1.3  christos 	      if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8207  1.3  christos 		relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8208  1.6  christos 			      + htab->glink->output_offset
   8209  1.3  christos 			      + ent->glink_offset);
   8210  1.3  christos 	      else
   8211  1.3  christos 		relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8212  1.3  christos 			      + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8213  1.3  christos 			      + ent->plt.offset);
   8214  1.7  christos 	    }
   8215  1.7  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8216  1.7  christos 
   8217  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_RELAX:
   8218  1.3  christos 	  {
   8219  1.3  christos 	    const int *stub;
   8220  1.3  christos 	    size_t size;
   8221  1.3  christos 	    size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
   8222  1.3  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   8223  1.3  christos 
   8224  1.3  christos 	    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8225  1.1  christos 	      {
   8226  1.1  christos 		relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
   8227  1.6  christos 			       + input_section->output_offset
   8228  1.3  christos 			       + rel->r_offset - 4);
   8229  1.1  christos 		stub = shared_stub_entry;
   8230  1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
   8231  1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
   8232  1.3  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
   8233  1.7  christos 		stub += 3;
   8234  1.3  christos 		size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
   8235  1.3  christos 	      }
   8236  1.3  christos 	    else
   8237  1.3  christos 	      {
   8238  1.7  christos 		stub = stub_entry;
   8239  1.3  christos 		size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
   8240  1.3  christos 	      }
   8241  1.3  christos 
   8242  1.3  christos 	    relocation += addend;
   8243  1.3  christos 	    if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
   8244  1.3  christos 	      relocation = 0;
   8245  1.3  christos 
   8246  1.7  christos 	    /* First insn is HA, second is LO.  */
   8247  1.3  christos 	    insn = *stub++;
   8248  1.3  christos 	    insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
   8249  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8250  1.1  christos 	    insn_offset += 4;
   8251  1.1  christos 
   8252  1.1  christos 	    insn = *stub++;
   8253  1.1  christos 	    insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
   8254  1.6  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8255  1.6  christos 	    insn_offset += 4;
   8256  1.6  christos 	    size -= 2;
   8257  1.6  christos 
   8258  1.6  christos 	    while (size != 0)
   8259  1.6  christos 	      {
   8260  1.6  christos 		insn = *stub++;
   8261  1.1  christos 		--size;
   8262  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
   8263  1.1  christos 		insn_offset += 4;
   8264  1.1  christos 	      }
   8265  1.1  christos 
   8266  1.1  christos 	    /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
   8267  1.1  christos 	       relocs to describe this relocation.  */
   8268  1.1  christos 	    BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
   8269  1.1  christos 	    /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
   8270  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
   8271  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   8272  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
   8273  1.1  christos 	    memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
   8274  1.1  christos 	    wrel++, rel++;
   8275  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_offset += 4;
   8276  1.1  christos 	    wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   8277  1.1  christos 	  }
   8278  1.1  christos 	  continue;
   8279  1.1  christos 
   8280  1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata relocation.  */
   8281  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
   8282  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
   8283  1.1  christos 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
   8284  1.1  christos 	    {
   8285  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8286  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8287  1.1  christos 	    }
   8288  1.1  christos 	  relocation
   8289  1.1  christos 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
   8290  1.1  christos 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8291  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8292  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8293  1.1  christos 
   8294  1.1  christos 	  /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation.  */
   8295  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
   8296  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
   8297  1.1  christos 	  if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
   8298  1.1  christos 	    {
   8299  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8300  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8301  1.1  christos 	    }
   8302  1.9  christos 	  relocation
   8303  1.9  christos 	    = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
   8304  1.1  christos 						 h, relocation, rel);
   8305  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8306  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8307  1.1  christos 
   8308  1.1  christos 	  /* Handle the TOC16 reloc.  We want to use the offset within the .got
   8309  1.1  christos 	     section, not the actual VMA.  This is appropriate when generating
   8310  1.1  christos 	     an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
   8311  1.6  christos 	     AIX .toc section.  */
   8312  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_TOC16:			/* phony GOT16 relocations */
   8313  1.6  christos 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8314  1.6  christos 	    {
   8315  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8316  1.7  christos 	      break;
   8317  1.1  christos 	    }
   8318  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
   8319  1.1  christos 		      || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
   8320  1.1  christos 
   8321  1.1  christos 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
   8322  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8323  1.1  christos 
   8324  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
   8325  1.1  christos 	  if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
   8326  1.1  christos 	    {
   8327  1.1  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8328  1.1  christos 
   8329  1.1  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
   8330  1.1  christos 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8331  1.1  christos 	      if (ent == NULL
   8332  1.7  christos 		  || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
   8333  1.7  christos 		{
   8334  1.1  christos 		  /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol.  This
   8335  1.1  christos 		     happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
   8336  1.1  christos 		     using -Bsymbolic.  */
   8337  1.1  christos 		}
   8338  1.1  christos 	      else
   8339  1.1  christos 		{
   8340  1.1  christos 		  /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
   8341  1.1  christos 		     procedure linkage table.  */
   8342  1.1  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8343  1.1  christos 		  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
   8344  1.8  christos 		    relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   8345  1.8  christos 				  + htab->glink->output_offset
   8346  1.8  christos 				  + ent->glink_offset);
   8347  1.8  christos 		  else
   8348  1.8  christos 		    relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   8349  1.8  christos 				  + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   8350  1.8  christos 				  + ent->plt.offset);
   8351  1.8  christos 		}
   8352  1.8  christos 	    }
   8353  1.8  christos 
   8354  1.8  christos 	  /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special.  If non-zero, the
   8355  1.8  christos 	     addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
   8356  1.8  christos 	     Don't apply it to the relocation field.  */
   8357  1.8  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8358  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8359  1.8  christos 
   8360  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8361  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8362  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8363  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
   8364  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8365  1.8  christos 	  plt_list = NULL;
   8366  1.8  christos 	  if (h != NULL)
   8367  1.8  christos 	    plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
   8368  1.8  christos 	  else if (ifunc != NULL)
   8369  1.8  christos 	    plt_list = ifunc;
   8370  1.8  christos 	  else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
   8371  1.8  christos 	    {
   8372  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry **local_plt;
   8373  1.8  christos 	      local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
   8374  1.8  christos 						 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
   8375  1.8  christos 	      plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
   8376  1.8  christos 	    }
   8377  1.8  christos 	  unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8378  1.8  christos 	  if (plt_list != NULL)
   8379  1.8  christos 	    {
   8380  1.8  christos 	      struct plt_entry *ent;
   8381  1.8  christos 
   8382  1.8  christos 	      ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
   8383  1.8  christos 				  bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
   8384  1.8  christos 	      if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   8385  1.8  christos 		{
   8386  1.8  christos 		  asection *plt;
   8387  1.8  christos 
   8388  1.8  christos 		  unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8389  1.8  christos 		  plt = htab->elf.splt;
   8390  1.8  christos 		  if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   8391  1.8  christos 		      || h == NULL
   8392  1.8  christos 		      || h->dynindx == -1)
   8393  1.8  christos 		    {
   8394  1.8  christos 		      if (ifunc != NULL)
   8395  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   8396  1.8  christos 		      else
   8397  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   8398  1.8  christos 		    }
   8399  1.8  christos 		  relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
   8400  1.8  christos 				+ plt->output_offset
   8401  1.8  christos 				+ ent->plt.offset);
   8402  1.8  christos 		  if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   8403  1.1  christos 		    {
   8404  1.1  christos 		      bfd_vma got = 0;
   8405  1.1  christos 
   8406  1.1  christos 		      if (ent->addend >= 32768)
   8407  1.1  christos 			got = (ent->addend
   8408  1.1  christos 			       + ent->sec->output_section->vma
   8409  1.1  christos 			       + ent->sec->output_offset);
   8410  1.1  christos 		      else
   8411  1.1  christos 			got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   8412  1.1  christos 		      relocation -= got;
   8413  1.1  christos 		    }
   8414  1.1  christos 		}
   8415  1.1  christos 	    }
   8416  1.1  christos 	  addend = 0;
   8417  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8418  1.9  christos 
   8419  1.3  christos 	  /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_.  */
   8420  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8421  1.1  christos 	  {
   8422  1.8  christos 	    const char *name;
   8423  1.7  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8424  1.8  christos 
   8425  1.8  christos 	    if (sec == NULL
   8426  1.1  christos 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8427  1.1  christos 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8428  1.1  christos 	      {
   8429  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8430  1.1  christos 		break;
   8431  1.1  christos 	      }
   8432  1.1  christos 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8433  1.1  christos 
   8434  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8435  1.1  christos 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8436  1.1  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
   8437  1.1  christos 	      {
   8438  1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8439  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8440  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8441  1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8442  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8443  1.1  christos 		   sym_name,
   8444  1.1  christos 		   howto->name,
   8445  1.1  christos 		   name);
   8446  1.1  christos 	      }
   8447  1.1  christos 	  }
   8448  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8449  1.9  christos 
   8450  1.3  christos 	  /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_.  */
   8451  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
   8452  1.1  christos 	  {
   8453  1.8  christos 	    const char *name;
   8454  1.7  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8455  1.8  christos 
   8456  1.8  christos 	    if (sec == NULL
   8457  1.1  christos 		|| sec->output_section == NULL
   8458  1.1  christos 		|| !is_static_defined (sda))
   8459  1.1  christos 	      {
   8460  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8461  1.1  christos 		break;
   8462  1.1  christos 	      }
   8463  1.1  christos 	    addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8464  1.1  christos 
   8465  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8466  1.3  christos 	    if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8467  1.7  christos 		  || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
   8468  1.7  christos 	      {
   8469  1.7  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8470  1.6  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8471  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8472  1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8473  1.3  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8474  1.7  christos 		   sym_name,
   8475  1.7  christos 		   howto->name,
   8476  1.7  christos 		   name);
   8477  1.6  christos 	      }
   8478  1.1  christos 	  }
   8479  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8480  1.3  christos 
   8481  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
   8482  1.7  christos 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8483  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8484  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8485  1.1  christos 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8486  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8487  1.3  christos 
   8488  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
   8489  1.7  christos 	  relocation = relocation + addend;
   8490  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8491  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8492  1.1  christos 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8493  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8494  1.3  christos 
   8495  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
   8496  1.7  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8497  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8498  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8499  1.1  christos 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8500  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8501  1.3  christos 
   8502  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
   8503  1.7  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
   8504  1.7  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8505  1.6  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8506  1.1  christos 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8507  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8508  1.1  christos 
   8509  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
   8510  1.1  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8511  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8512  1.1  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8513  1.1  christos 			       split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8514  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8515  1.3  christos 
   8516  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
   8517  1.1  christos 	  relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8518  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8519  1.1  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
   8520  1.1  christos 			       split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8521  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8522  1.1  christos 
   8523  1.1  christos 	  /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0.  */
   8524  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
   8525  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
   8526  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
   8527  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
   8528  1.1  christos 	  {
   8529  1.1  christos 	    const char *name;
   8530  1.1  christos 	    int reg;
   8531  1.3  christos 	    unsigned int insn;
   8532  1.3  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8533  1.1  christos 
   8534  1.1  christos 	    if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8535  1.1  christos 	      {
   8536  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8537  1.1  christos 		break;
   8538  1.1  christos 	      }
   8539  1.1  christos 
   8540  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8541  1.1  christos 	    if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8542  1.1  christos 		|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8543  1.1  christos 	      {
   8544  1.8  christos 		reg = 13;
   8545  1.7  christos 		sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8546  1.8  christos 	      }
   8547  1.8  christos 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8548  1.1  christos 		     || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8549  1.1  christos 	      {
   8550  1.1  christos 		reg = 2;
   8551  1.1  christos 		sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8552  1.1  christos 	      }
   8553  1.1  christos 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
   8554  1.1  christos 		     || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
   8555  1.6  christos 	      {
   8556  1.1  christos 		reg = 0;
   8557  1.1  christos 	      }
   8558  1.1  christos 	    else
   8559  1.1  christos 	      {
   8560  1.1  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8561  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8562  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8563  1.1  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8564  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8565  1.1  christos 		   sym_name,
   8566  1.1  christos 		   howto->name,
   8567  1.1  christos 		   name);
   8568  1.9  christos 
   8569  1.9  christos 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8570  1.9  christos 		ret = FALSE;
   8571  1.9  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8572  1.9  christos 	      }
   8573  1.9  christos 
   8574  1.9  christos 	    if (sda != NULL)
   8575  1.9  christos 	      {
   8576  1.9  christos 		if (!is_static_defined (sda))
   8577  1.9  christos 		  {
   8578  1.9  christos 		    unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8579  1.9  christos 		    break;
   8580  1.9  christos 		  }
   8581  1.7  christos 		addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
   8582  1.1  christos 	      }
   8583  1.1  christos 
   8584  1.1  christos 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
   8585  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8586  1.3  christos 
   8587  1.3  christos 	    /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
   8588  1.3  christos 	       version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
   8589  1.3  christos 	       operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset.  GNU as and
   8590  1.3  christos 	       GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
   8591  1.3  christos 	       a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset.  Cope with object file
   8592  1.3  christos 	       producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
   8593  1.3  christos 	       generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects.  */
   8594  1.3  christos 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
   8595  1.3  christos 	      rel->r_offset &= ~1;
   8596  1.3  christos 
   8597  1.3  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8598  1.3  christos 	    if (reg == 0
   8599  1.3  christos 		&& (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8600  1.3  christos 		    || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
   8601  1.7  christos 	      {
   8602  1.3  christos 		relocation = relocation + addend;
   8603  1.3  christos 		addend = 0;
   8604  1.3  christos 
   8605  1.3  christos 		/* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn.  */
   8606  1.6  christos 		insn &= 0x1f << 21;
   8607  1.1  christos 		insn |= 28u << 26;
   8608  1.9  christos 
   8609  1.9  christos 		/* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31.  */
   8610  1.7  christos 		/* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20.  */
   8611  1.1  christos 		insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
   8612  1.1  christos 		/* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15.  */
   8613  1.1  christos 		insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
   8614  1.1  christos 		/* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31.  */
   8615  1.1  christos 		insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
   8616  1.1  christos 
   8617  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8618  1.1  christos 
   8619  1.1  christos 		if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
   8620  1.1  christos 		    && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
   8621  1.1  christos 		  goto overflow;
   8622  1.1  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8623  1.1  christos 	      }
   8624  1.1  christos 	    /* Fill in register field.  */
   8625  1.1  christos 	    insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
   8626  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8627  1.1  christos 	  }
   8628  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8629  1.1  christos 
   8630  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
   8631  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
   8632  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
   8633  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
   8634  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
   8635  1.3  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
   8636  1.3  christos 	  {
   8637  1.7  christos 	    bfd_vma value;
   8638  1.1  christos 	    const char *name;
   8639  1.1  christos 	    struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
   8640  1.7  christos 
   8641  1.7  christos 	    if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8642  1.8  christos 	      {
   8643  1.1  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8644  1.1  christos 		break;
   8645  1.1  christos 	      }
   8646  1.1  christos 
   8647  1.1  christos 	    name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
   8648  1.1  christos 	    if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
   8649  1.1  christos 		|| strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
   8650  1.1  christos 	      sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
   8651  1.6  christos 	    else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
   8652  1.1  christos 		     || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
   8653  1.1  christos 	      sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
   8654  1.7  christos 	    else
   8655  1.1  christos 	      {
   8656  1.7  christos 		_bfd_error_handler
   8657  1.7  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8658  1.1  christos 		  (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
   8659  1.7  christos 		     "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
   8660  1.3  christos 		   input_bfd,
   8661  1.3  christos 		   sym_name,
   8662  1.7  christos 		   howto->name,
   8663  1.7  christos 		   name);
   8664  1.7  christos 
   8665  1.7  christos 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8666  1.3  christos 		ret = FALSE;
   8667  1.7  christos 		goto copy_reloc;
   8668  1.7  christos 	      }
   8669  1.7  christos 
   8670  1.7  christos 	    if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
   8671  1.3  christos 	      {
   8672  1.3  christos 		unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8673  1.3  christos 		break;
   8674  1.7  christos 	      }
   8675  1.7  christos 	    value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
   8676  1.7  christos 
   8677  1.7  christos 	    if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
   8678  1.3  christos 	      ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8679  1.3  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8680  1.3  christos 				   split16a_type,
   8681  1.3  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8682  1.7  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
   8683  1.7  christos 	      ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8684  1.7  christos 				   contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8685  1.7  christos 				   split16d_type,
   8686  1.3  christos 				   htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8687  1.3  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
   8688  1.3  christos 	      {
   8689  1.3  christos 		value = value >> 16;
   8690  1.7  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8691  1.7  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8692  1.7  christos 				     split16a_type,
   8693  1.7  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8694  1.3  christos 	      }
   8695  1.3  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
   8696  1.3  christos 	      {
   8697  1.3  christos 		value = value >> 16;
   8698  1.7  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8699  1.7  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8700  1.7  christos 				     split16d_type,
   8701  1.7  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8702  1.1  christos 	      }
   8703  1.1  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
   8704  1.6  christos 	      {
   8705  1.1  christos 		value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8706  1.8  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8707  1.8  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8708  1.9  christos 				     split16a_type,
   8709  1.8  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8710  1.1  christos 	      }
   8711  1.1  christos 	    else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
   8712  1.1  christos 	      {
   8713  1.1  christos 		value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
   8714  1.1  christos 		ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8715  1.1  christos 				     contents + rel->r_offset, value,
   8716  1.1  christos 				     split16d_type,
   8717  1.1  christos 				     htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
   8718  1.1  christos 	      }
   8719  1.1  christos 	  }
   8720  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8721  1.1  christos 
   8722  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
   8723  1.1  christos 	  ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
   8724  1.1  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8725  1.1  christos 
   8726  1.1  christos 	  /* Relocate against the beginning of the section.  */
   8727  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8728  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8729  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
   8730  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8731  1.1  christos 	  if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
   8732  1.1  christos 	    {
   8733  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
   8734  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8735  1.1  christos 	    }
   8736  1.1  christos 	  addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
   8737  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8738  1.1  christos 
   8739  1.1  christos 	  /* Negative relocations.  */
   8740  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
   8741  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
   8742  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
   8743  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
   8744  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8745  1.8  christos 	  addend -= 2 * relocation;
   8746  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8747  1.8  christos 
   8748  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_COPY:
   8749  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
   8750  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   8751  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   8752  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
   8753  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT32:
   8754  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
   8755  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   8756  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
   8757  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
   8758  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
   8759  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8760  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
   8761  1.9  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8762  1.9  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
   8763  1.9  christos 			      input_bfd, howto->name);
   8764  1.9  christos 
   8765  1.9  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
   8766  1.9  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   8767  1.9  christos 	  goto copy_reloc;
   8768  1.9  christos 	}
   8769  1.9  christos 
   8770  1.9  christos       switch (r_type)
   8771  1.9  christos 	{
   8772  1.9  christos 	default:
   8773  1.9  christos 	  break;
   8774  1.9  christos 
   8775  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8776  1.9  christos 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   8777  1.9  christos 	    {
   8778  1.9  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8779  1.9  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8780  1.9  christos 	    }
   8781  1.9  christos 	  break;
   8782  1.9  christos 
   8783  1.9  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8784  1.8  christos 	  if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   8785  1.8  christos 	    {
   8786  1.8  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8787  1.8  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8788  1.8  christos 	      insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
   8789  1.8  christos 	      insn |= 2 << 16;
   8790  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
   8791  1.8  christos 	    }
   8792  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8793  1.8  christos 	}
   8794  1.8  christos 
   8795  1.8  christos       switch (r_type)
   8796  1.8  christos 	{
   8797  1.8  christos 	default:
   8798  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8799  1.8  christos 
   8800  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
   8801  1.8  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8802  1.8  christos 	    {
   8803  1.8  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
   8804  1.8  christos 	      unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
   8805  1.8  christos 	      insn &= 1;
   8806  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
   8807  1.8  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
   8808  1.8  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
   8809  1.8  christos 	      howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8810  1.8  christos 	    }
   8811  1.8  christos 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8812  1.8  christos 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8813  1.8  christos 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8814  1.8  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8815  1.8  christos 	       howto->name);
   8816  1.8  christos 	  break;
   8817  1.8  christos 
   8818  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
   8819  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8820  1.8  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
   8821  1.1  christos 	  if (unresolved_reloc)
   8822  1.1  christos 	    {
   8823  1.1  christos 	      bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
   8824  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
   8825  1.1  christos 	      unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
   8826  1.1  christos 	      r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
   8827  1.1  christos 	      howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
   8828  1.1  christos 	    }
   8829  1.6  christos 	  else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
   8830  1.1  christos 	    info->callbacks->einfo
   8831  1.1  christos 	      (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
   8832  1.1  christos 	       input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8833  1.1  christos 	       howto->name);
   8834  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8835  1.1  christos 	}
   8836  1.1  christos 
   8837  1.1  christos       /* Do any further special processing.  */
   8838  1.1  christos       switch (r_type)
   8839  1.1  christos 	{
   8840  1.1  christos 	default:
   8841  1.7  christos 	  break;
   8842  1.1  christos 
   8843  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
   8844  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   8845  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
   8846  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
   8847  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
   8848  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
   8849  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
   8850  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
   8851  1.1  christos 	  /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
   8852  1.1  christos 	     that's not actually defined anywhere.  In that case,
   8853  1.1  christos 	     'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
   8854  1.1  christos 	     alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link).  */
   8855  1.1  christos 	  if (sec == NULL)
   8856  1.1  christos 	    break;
   8857  1.1  christos 	  /* Fall through.  */
   8858  1.1  christos 
   8859  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
   8860  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
   8861  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
   8862  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
   8863  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
   8864  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
   8865  1.1  christos 	  /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
   8866  1.1  christos 	     Bits 0:15 are not used.  */
   8867  1.1  christos 	  addend += 0x8000;
   8868  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8869  1.1  christos 
   8870  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16:
   8871  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
   8872  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16:
   8873  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
   8874  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
   8875  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
   8876  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
   8877  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
   8878  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
   8879  1.7  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16:
   8880  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
   8881  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
   8882  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
   8883  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
   8884  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
   8885  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
   8886  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
   8887  1.1  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
   8888  1.6  christos 	case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
   8889  1.6  christos 	  {
   8890  1.6  christos 	    /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
   8891  1.1  christos 	       certain 64-bit instructions.  Prevent damage to bits
   8892  1.1  christos 	       that make up part of the insn opcode.  */
   8893  1.6  christos 	    unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
   8894  1.1  christos 
   8895  1.7  christos 	    insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
   8896  1.7  christos 			       contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
   8897  1.1  christos 	    mask = 0;
   8898  1.1  christos 	    if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
   8899  1.1  christos 	      mask = 3;
   8900  1.1  christos 	    else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
   8901  1.1  christos 	      mask = 15;
   8902  1.1  christos 	    else
   8903  1.1  christos 	      break;
   8904  1.1  christos 	    relocation += addend;
   8905  1.1  christos 	    addend = insn & mask;
   8906  1.1  christos 	    lobit = mask & relocation;
   8907  1.1  christos 	    if (lobit != 0)
   8908  1.1  christos 	      {
   8909  1.1  christos 		relocation ^= lobit;
   8910  1.1  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   8911  1.1  christos 		  /* xgettext:c-format */
   8912  1.1  christos 		  (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
   8913  1.1  christos 		   input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8914  1.1  christos 		   howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
   8915  1.1  christos 		bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   8916  1.1  christos 		ret = FALSE;
   8917  1.1  christos 	      }
   8918  1.1  christos 	  }
   8919  1.1  christos 	  break;
   8920  1.1  christos 	}
   8921  1.1  christos 
   8922  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   8923  1.1  christos       fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
   8924  1.7  christos 	       "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
   8925  1.7  christos 	       howto->name,
   8926  1.1  christos 	       (int) r_type,
   8927  1.1  christos 	       sym_name,
   8928  1.1  christos 	       r_symndx,
   8929  1.1  christos 	       (long) rel->r_offset,
   8930  1.1  christos 	       (long) addend);
   8931  1.1  christos #endif
   8932  1.3  christos 
   8933  1.3  christos       if (unresolved_reloc
   8934  1.3  christos 	  && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
   8935  1.3  christos 	       && h->def_dynamic)
   8936  1.3  christos 	  && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
   8937  1.3  christos 				      rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
   8938  1.3  christos 	{
   8939  1.3  christos 	  info->callbacks->einfo
   8940  1.3  christos 	    /* xgettext:c-format */
   8941  1.3  christos 	    (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
   8942  1.3  christos 	     input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   8943  1.3  christos 	     howto->name,
   8944  1.3  christos 	     sym_name);
   8945  1.3  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   8946  1.9  christos 	}
   8947  1.3  christos 
   8948  1.9  christos       /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
   8949  1.9  christos 	 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values.  Really, we should
   8950  1.9  christos 	 have different reloc types.  */
   8951  1.3  christos       if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
   8952  1.3  christos 	  && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
   8953  1.3  christos 	  && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
   8954  1.3  christos 	{
   8955  1.3  christos 	  enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
   8956  1.3  christos 
   8957  1.3  christos 	  if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
   8958  1.3  christos 	    {
   8959  1.3  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   8960  1.3  christos 
   8961  1.6  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
   8962  1.6  christos 	      if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
   8963  1.6  christos 		complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
   8964  1.6  christos 	      else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
   8965  1.6  christos 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
   8966  1.6  christos 		       || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
   8967  1.6  christos 		complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
   8968  1.6  christos 	    }
   8969  1.6  christos 	  if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
   8970  1.6  christos 	    {
   8971  1.6  christos 	      alt_howto = *howto;
   8972  1.6  christos 	      alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
   8973  1.6  christos 	      howto = &alt_howto;
   8974  1.6  christos 	    }
   8975  1.6  christos 	}
   8976  1.6  christos 
   8977  1.6  christos       if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
   8978  1.6  christos 	{
   8979  1.6  christos 	  /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate.  */
   8980  1.6  christos 	  if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
   8981  1.6  christos 	    r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
   8982  1.6  christos 	  else
   8983  1.6  christos 	    {
   8984  1.6  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   8985  1.1  christos 
   8986  1.1  christos 	      relocation += addend;
   8987  1.1  christos 	      relocation -= (rel->r_offset
   8988  1.1  christos 			     + input_section->output_offset
   8989  1.1  christos 			     + input_section->output_section->vma);
   8990  1.3  christos 	      relocation >>= 16;
   8991  1.5  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8992  1.5  christos 	      insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
   8993  1.5  christos 	      insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
   8994  1.5  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
   8995  1.5  christos 	      r = bfd_reloc_ok;
   8996  1.5  christos 	    }
   8997  1.5  christos 	}
   8998  1.6  christos       else
   8999  1.6  christos 	r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
   9000  1.6  christos 				      rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
   9001  1.1  christos 
   9002  1.1  christos       if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
   9003  1.1  christos 	{
   9004  1.1  christos 	  if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
   9005  1.7  christos 	    {
   9006  1.7  christos 	    overflow:
   9007  1.1  christos 	      /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
   9008  1.1  christos 		 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined.  */
   9009  1.1  christos 	      if (!warned
   9010  1.1  christos 		  && !(h != NULL
   9011  1.1  christos 		       && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
   9012  1.6  christos 			   || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
   9013  1.6  christos 		       && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
   9014  1.6  christos 		info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
   9015  1.6  christos 		  (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
   9016  1.6  christos 		   rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
   9017  1.6  christos 	    }
   9018  1.6  christos 	  else
   9019  1.6  christos 	    {
   9020  1.6  christos 	      info->callbacks->einfo
   9021  1.6  christos 		/* xgettext:c-format */
   9022  1.6  christos 		(_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
   9023  1.6  christos 		 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
   9024  1.6  christos 		 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
   9025  1.6  christos 	      ret = FALSE;
   9026  1.6  christos 	    }
   9027  1.6  christos 	}
   9028  1.6  christos     copy_reloc:
   9029  1.6  christos       if (wrel != rel)
   9030  1.6  christos 	*wrel = *rel;
   9031  1.6  christos     }
   9032  1.6  christos 
   9033  1.6  christos   if (wrel != rel)
   9034  1.6  christos     {
   9035  1.6  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
   9036  1.6  christos       size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
   9037  1.1  christos 
   9038  1.1  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
   9039  1.1  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9040  1.1  christos       if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
   9041  1.1  christos 	{
   9042  1.1  christos 	  /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section.  Leave
   9043  1.3  christos 	     one NONE reloc.
   9044  1.3  christos 	     ??? What is wrong with an empty section???  */
   9045  1.3  christos 	  rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
   9046  1.3  christos 	  deleted -= 1;
   9047  1.3  christos 	  wrel++;
   9048  1.3  christos 	}
   9049  1.3  christos       relend = wrel;
   9050  1.3  christos       rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
   9051  1.3  christos       rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
   9052  1.3  christos       input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
   9053  1.3  christos     }
   9054  1.3  christos 
   9055  1.6  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9056  1.3  christos   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9057  1.3  christos #endif
   9058  1.3  christos 
   9059  1.3  christos   if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9060  1.3  christos       && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
   9061  1.3  christos       && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
   9062  1.3  christos 	  || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
   9063  1.3  christos     {
   9064  1.3  christos       /* Branch around the trampolines.  */
   9065  1.3  christos       unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
   9066  1.3  christos       bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
   9067  1.3  christos     }
   9068  1.3  christos 
   9069  1.3  christos   if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
   9070  1.3  christos       && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
   9071  1.3  christos       && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
   9072  1.3  christos 	  || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
   9073  1.3  christos 	      >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
   9074  1.3  christos     {
   9075  1.3  christos       bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
   9076  1.3  christos       bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   9077  1.3  christos 
   9078  1.3  christos       if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
   9079  1.3  christos 	{
   9080  1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte *p;
   9081  1.3  christos 	  unsigned int n;
   9082  1.3  christos 	  bfd_byte fill[4];
   9083  1.3  christos 
   9084  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
   9085  1.3  christos 	  p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
   9086  1.3  christos 	  n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
   9087  1.3  christos 	  while (n--)
   9088  1.3  christos 	    {
   9089  1.3  christos 	      memcpy (p, fill, 4);
   9090  1.3  christos 	      p += 4;
   9091  1.3  christos 	    }
   9092  1.3  christos 	}
   9093  1.3  christos 
   9094  1.3  christos       /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
   9095  1.3  christos 	 branch to a patch area.  Put the insn there followed by a
   9096  1.3  christos 	 branch back to the next page.  Complicated a little by
   9097  1.3  christos 	 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
   9098  1.3  christos 	 wanting to touch data-in-text.  */
   9099  1.3  christos 
   9100  1.3  christos       start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
   9101  1.3  christos 		    + input_section->output_offset);
   9102  1.3  christos       end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9103  1.3  christos 		  - relax_info->workaround_size);
   9104  1.3  christos       for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
   9105  1.3  christos 	   addr < end_addr;
   9106  1.3  christos 	   addr += pagesize)
   9107  1.3  christos 	{
   9108  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
   9109  1.3  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
   9110  1.3  christos 	  bfd_boolean is_data;
   9111  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
   9112  1.3  christos 	  unsigned int insn;
   9113  1.3  christos 
   9114  1.3  christos 	  /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset?  If so, leave
   9115  1.3  christos 	     the word alone.  */
   9116  1.3  christos 	  is_data = FALSE;
   9117  1.3  christos 	  lo = relocs;
   9118  1.3  christos 	  hi = relend;
   9119  1.3  christos 	  rel = NULL;
   9120  1.3  christos 	  while (lo < hi)
   9121  1.3  christos 	    {
   9122  1.3  christos 	      rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
   9123  1.3  christos 	      if (rel->r_offset < offset)
   9124  1.3  christos 		lo = rel + 1;
   9125  1.3  christos 	      else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
   9126  1.3  christos 		hi = rel;
   9127  1.3  christos 	      else
   9128  1.3  christos 		{
   9129  1.3  christos 		  switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
   9130  1.3  christos 		    {
   9131  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_ADDR32:
   9132  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_UADDR32:
   9133  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_REL32:
   9134  1.3  christos 		    case R_PPC_ADDR30:
   9135  1.3  christos 		      is_data = TRUE;
   9136  1.3  christos 		      break;
   9137  1.3  christos 		    default:
   9138  1.3  christos 		      break;
   9139  1.3  christos 		    }
   9140  1.3  christos 		  break;
   9141  1.3  christos 		}
   9142  1.3  christos 	    }
   9143  1.3  christos 	  if (is_data)
   9144  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   9145  1.3  christos 
   9146  1.3  christos 	  /* Some instructions can be left alone too.  Unconditional
   9147  1.3  christos 	     branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
   9148  1.3  christos 	     avoid the icache failure.
   9149  1.3  christos 
   9150  1.3  christos 	     The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
   9151  1.3  christos 	     where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
   9152  1.3  christos 	     page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
   9153  1.3  christos 	     instructions fails under certain circumstances.  The
   9154  1.3  christos 	     unconditional branches:
   9155  1.3  christos 	     1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
   9156  1.3  christos 	     2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
   9157  1.3  christos 	     3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
   9158  1.3  christos 	     where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
   9159  1.3  christos 	     prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
   9160  1.3  christos 	     affected by these instructions.  This happens even if the
   9161  1.3  christos 	     instruction is not executed.
   9162  1.3  christos 
   9163  1.3  christos 	     A bctr example:
   9164  1.3  christos 	     .
   9165  1.6  christos 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha
   9166  1.6  christos 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9167  1.6  christos 	     .	mtctr 9
   9168  1.6  christos 	     .	bctr
   9169  1.3  christos 	     .	nop
   9170  1.6  christos 	     .	nop
   9171  1.6  christos 	     . new_page:
   9172  1.3  christos 	     .
   9173  1.3  christos 	     The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
   9174  1.9  christos 	     ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
   9175  1.9  christos 	     new page which might have stale instructions.  If they
   9176  1.8  christos 	     fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
   9177  1.9  christos 	     bctr executes.  Either of the following modifications
   9178  1.3  christos 	     prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
   9179  1.8  christos 	     place:
   9180  1.3  christos 	     .
   9181  1.3  christos 	     .	lis 9,new_page@ha	 lis 9,new_page@ha
   9182  1.3  christos 	     .	addi 9,9,new_page@l	 addi 9,9,new_page@l
   9183  1.3  christos 	     .	mtctr 9			 mtctr 9
   9184  1.3  christos 	     .	bctr			 bctr
   9185  1.3  christos 	     .	nop			 b somewhere_else
   9186  1.3  christos 	     .	b somewhere_else	 nop
   9187  1.3  christos 	     . new_page:		new_page:
   9188  1.3  christos 	     .  */
   9189  1.3  christos 	  insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
   9190  1.3  christos 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26)	    /* b,bl,ba,bla */
   9191  1.3  christos 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26)	    /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
   9192  1.5  christos 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9193  1.5  christos 	      || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
   9194  1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1)    /* bclr,bclrl */
   9195  1.3  christos 		  && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/*	 with BO=0x14 */
   9196  1.3  christos 	    continue;
   9197  1.3  christos 
   9198  1.3  christos 	  patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
   9199  1.3  christos 			- relax_info->workaround_size);
   9200  1.3  christos 	  patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
   9201  1.3  christos 	  patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
   9202  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
   9203  1.3  christos 
   9204  1.3  christos 	  if (rel != NULL
   9205  1.3  christos 	      && rel->r_offset >= offset
   9206  1.5  christos 	      && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
   9207  1.5  christos 	    {
   9208  1.5  christos 	      asection *sreloc;
   9209  1.5  christos 
   9210  1.5  christos 	      /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
   9211  1.5  christos 		 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
   9212  1.5  christos 		 location.  This matters for -r and --emit-relocs.  */
   9213  1.5  christos 	      if (rel + 1 != relend)
   9214  1.5  christos 		{
   9215  1.5  christos 		  Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
   9216  1.5  christos 
   9217  1.5  christos 		  /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset.  */
   9218  1.5  christos 		  memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
   9219  1.5  christos 		  relend[-1] = tmp;
   9220  1.5  christos 		}
   9221  1.5  christos 	      relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9222  1.5  christos 
   9223  1.5  christos 	      /* Adjust REL16 addends too.  */
   9224  1.5  christos 	      switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
   9225  1.5  christos 		{
   9226  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16:
   9227  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
   9228  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
   9229  1.5  christos 		case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
   9230  1.5  christos 		  relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
   9231  1.5  christos 		  break;
   9232  1.5  christos 		default:
   9233  1.5  christos 		  break;
   9234  1.5  christos 		}
   9235  1.5  christos 
   9236  1.5  christos 	      /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
   9237  1.5  christos 		 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
   9238  1.5  christos 		 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn.  */
   9239  1.5  christos 	      sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
   9240  1.5  christos 	      if (sreloc != NULL)
   9241  1.5  christos 		{
   9242  1.5  christos 		  Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
   9243  1.5  christos 		  bfd_vma soffset;
   9244  1.5  christos 
   9245  1.5  christos 		  slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
   9246  1.5  christos 		  shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
   9247  1.5  christos 		  soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
   9248  1.5  christos 			     + input_section->output_offset);
   9249  1.5  christos 		  while (slo < shi)
   9250  1.5  christos 		    {
   9251  1.5  christos 		      Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
   9252  1.5  christos 		      bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
   9253  1.5  christos 						&outrel);
   9254  1.5  christos 		      if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
   9255  1.5  christos 			slo = srel + 1;
   9256  1.5  christos 		      else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
   9257  1.3  christos 			shi = srel;
   9258  1.3  christos 		      else
   9259  1.3  christos 			{
   9260  1.3  christos 			  if (srel + 1 != srelend)
   9261  1.9  christos 			    {
   9262  1.3  christos 			      memmove (srel, srel + 1,
   9263  1.3  christos 				       (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
   9264  1.3  christos 			      srel = srelend - 1;
   9265  1.3  christos 			    }
   9266  1.3  christos 			  outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
   9267  1.6  christos 			  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
   9268  1.3  christos 						     (bfd_byte *) srel);
   9269  1.6  christos 			  break;
   9270  1.3  christos 			}
   9271  1.3  christos 		    }
   9272  1.3  christos 		}
   9273  1.3  christos 	    }
   9274  1.3  christos 	  else
   9275  1.3  christos 	    rel = NULL;
   9276  1.3  christos 
   9277  1.3  christos 	  if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
   9278  1.3  christos 	      && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
   9279  1.3  christos 	    {
   9280  1.3  christos 	      bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
   9281  1.3  christos 
   9282  1.3  christos 	      delta += offset - patch_off;
   9283  1.3  christos 	      if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9284  1.3  christos 		delta = 0;
   9285  1.3  christos 	      if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
   9286  1.3  christos 		{
   9287  1.3  christos 		  enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
   9288  1.3  christos 
   9289  1.3  christos 		  r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
   9290  1.3  christos 		  if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
   9291  1.3  christos 		    insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9292  1.3  christos 		  else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9293  1.3  christos 		    insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9294  1.3  christos 		  else
   9295  1.3  christos 		    BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
   9296  1.3  christos 
   9297  1.3  christos 		  if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
   9298  1.3  christos 		       || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
   9299  1.3  christos 		      && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
   9300  1.3  christos 		      && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
   9301  1.3  christos 		    insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
   9302  1.3  christos 		}
   9303  1.3  christos 	      if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
   9304  1.3  christos 		{
   9305  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9306  1.3  christos 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
   9307  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9308  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9309  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9310  1.3  christos 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9311  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9312  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9313  1.3  christos 		}
   9314  1.3  christos 	      else
   9315  1.3  christos 		{
   9316  1.3  christos 		  if (rel != NULL)
   9317  1.3  christos 		    {
   9318  1.3  christos 		      unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
   9319  1.3  christos 
   9320  1.3  christos 		      relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
   9321  1.3  christos 		      relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
   9322  1.3  christos 		    }
   9323  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9324  1.3  christos 			      (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
   9325  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9326  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9327  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9328  1.3  christos 			      B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9329  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9330  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9331  1.3  christos 		  bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9332  1.3  christos 			      B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
   9333  1.3  christos 			      contents + patch_off);
   9334  1.3  christos 		  patch_off += 4;
   9335  1.1  christos 		}
   9336  1.1  christos 	    }
   9337  1.1  christos 	  else
   9338  1.8  christos 	    {
   9339  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
   9340  1.1  christos 	      patch_off += 4;
   9341  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
   9342  1.1  christos 			  B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
   9343  1.8  christos 			  contents + patch_off);
   9344  1.8  christos 	      patch_off += 4;
   9345  1.1  christos 	    }
   9346  1.1  christos 	  BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
   9347  1.1  christos 	  relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
   9348  1.1  christos 	}
   9349  1.1  christos     }
   9350  1.1  christos 
   9351  1.1  christos   return ret;
   9352  1.1  christos }
   9353  1.1  christos 
   9354  1.1  christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H.  */
   9356  1.1  christos 
   9357  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   9358  1.8  christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
   9359  1.1  christos {
   9360  1.1  christos   struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
   9361  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9362  1.1  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9363  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean doneone;
   9364  1.1  christos 
   9365  1.1  christos   doneone = FALSE;
   9366  1.1  christos   for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9367  1.1  christos     if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9368  1.1  christos       {
   9369  1.1  christos 	if (!doneone)
   9370  1.1  christos 	  {
   9371  1.1  christos 	    Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9372  1.1  christos 	    bfd_byte *loc;
   9373  1.1  christos 	    bfd_vma reloc_index;
   9374  1.1  christos 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9375  1.1  christos 	    asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
   9376  1.1  christos 
   9377  1.1  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   9378  1.1  christos 		|| !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9379  1.1  christos 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
   9380  1.1  christos 	      reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
   9381  1.1  christos 	    else
   9382  1.1  christos 	      {
   9383  1.1  christos 		reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
   9384  1.1  christos 			       / htab->plt_slot_size);
   9385  1.1  christos 		if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
   9386  1.6  christos 		    && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   9387  1.1  christos 		  reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
   9388  1.1  christos 	      }
   9389  1.1  christos 
   9390  1.6  christos 	    /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
   9391  1.1  christos 	       Set it up.  */
   9392  1.8  christos 	    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
   9393  1.1  christos 		&& htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9394  1.8  christos 		&& h->dynindx != -1)
   9395  1.8  christos 	      {
   9396  1.1  christos 		bfd_vma got_offset;
   9397  1.8  christos 		const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
   9398  1.1  christos 
   9399  1.1  christos 		/* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved.  */
   9400  1.1  christos 		got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
   9401  1.1  christos 
   9402  1.1  christos 		/* Use the right PLT. */
   9403  1.8  christos 		plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
   9404  1.1  christos 			    : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
   9405  1.8  christos 
   9406  1.8  christos 		/* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks.  */
   9407  1.1  christos 		if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9408  1.8  christos 		  {
   9409  1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9410  1.1  christos 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
   9411  1.8  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9412  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9413  1.8  christos 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
   9414  1.8  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9415  1.1  christos 		  }
   9416  1.1  christos 		else
   9417  1.1  christos 		  {
   9418  1.1  christos 		    bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9419  1.1  christos 
   9420  1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9421  1.1  christos 				plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
   9422  1.8  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
   9423  1.1  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9424  1.8  christos 				plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
   9425  1.1  christos 				plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
   9426  1.1  christos 		  }
   9427  1.1  christos 
   9428  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
   9429  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
   9430  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
   9431  1.8  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
   9432  1.1  christos 
   9433  1.1  christos 		/* This instruction is an immediate load.  The value loaded is
   9434  1.8  christos 		   the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
   9435  1.8  christos 		   start of the .rela.plt section.  The value is stored in the
   9436  1.8  christos 		   low-order 16 bits of the load instruction.  */
   9437  1.8  christos 		/* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
   9438  1.8  christos 		   prescaled offset.  */
   9439  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9440  1.1  christos 			    plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
   9441  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
   9442  1.1  christos 		/* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
   9443  1.8  christos 		   the start of the PLT section.  The address of this branch
   9444  1.8  christos 		   instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
   9445  1.8  christos 		   The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive.  The value
   9446  1.7  christos 		   stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
   9447  1.1  christos 		   offset.  */
   9448  1.6  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
   9449  1.1  christos 			    (plt_entry[5]
   9450  1.1  christos 			     | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
   9451  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
   9452  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
   9453  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
   9454  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
   9455  1.1  christos 			    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
   9456  1.1  christos 
   9457  1.8  christos 		/* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
   9458  1.8  christos 		   the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
   9459  1.1  christos 		   in this PLT entry.  */
   9460  1.1  christos 		bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
   9461  1.1  christos 					       + plt->output_offset
   9462  1.1  christos 					       + ent->plt.offset + 16),
   9463  1.8  christos 			    htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
   9464  1.1  christos 
   9465  1.1  christos 		if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9466  1.1  christos 		  {
   9467  1.8  christos 		    /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded.  */
   9468  1.8  christos 		    loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
   9469  1.1  christos 		      + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
   9470  1.1  christos 			  * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
   9471  1.1  christos 			 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9472  1.1  christos 
   9473  1.8  christos 		    /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   9474  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9475  1.1  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9476  1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset + 2);
   9477  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9478  1.7  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   9479  1.7  christos 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9480  1.1  christos 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9481  1.1  christos 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9482  1.1  christos 
   9483  1.1  christos 		    /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   9484  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9485  1.1  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9486  1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset + 6);
   9487  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
   9488  1.1  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   9489  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_addend = got_offset;
   9490  1.1  christos 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9491  1.1  christos 		    loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9492  1.7  christos 
   9493  1.7  christos 		    /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
   9494  1.1  christos 		       PLT slot.  Point it at the middle of the .plt entry.  */
   9495  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9496  1.1  christos 				     + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9497  1.1  christos 				     + got_offset);
   9498  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
   9499  1.8  christos 						R_PPC_ADDR32);
   9500  1.1  christos 		    rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
   9501  1.1  christos 		    bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9502  1.8  christos 		  }
   9503  1.8  christos 
   9504  1.8  christos 		/* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
   9505  1.8  christos 		   In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
   9506  1.8  christos 		   address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
   9507  1.8  christos 		   by the ABI.  Instead, the offset is set to the address of
   9508  1.8  christos 		   the GOT slot for this function.  See EABI 4.4.4.1.  */
   9509  1.8  christos 		rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
   9510  1.8  christos 				 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
   9511  1.8  christos 				 + got_offset);
   9512  1.8  christos 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9513  1.8  christos 	      }
   9514  1.8  christos 	    else
   9515  1.8  christos 	      {
   9516  1.8  christos 		rela.r_addend = 0;
   9517  1.8  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9518  1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1)
   9519  1.8  christos 		  {
   9520  1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9521  1.8  christos 		      {
   9522  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9523  1.1  christos 			relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9524  1.1  christos 		      }
   9525  1.1  christos 		    else
   9526  1.8  christos 		      {
   9527  1.8  christos 			plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9528  1.8  christos 			relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
   9529  1.8  christos 		      }
   9530  1.8  christos 		    if (h->def_regular
   9531  1.8  christos 			&& (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
   9532  1.8  christos 			    || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
   9533  1.8  christos 		      rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
   9534  1.8  christos 		  }
   9535  1.8  christos 
   9536  1.8  christos 		if (relplt == NULL)
   9537  1.8  christos 		  {
   9538  1.8  christos 		    loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9539  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
   9540  1.8  christos 		  }
   9541  1.8  christos 		else
   9542  1.8  christos 		  {
   9543  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
   9544  1.8  christos 				     + plt->output_offset
   9545  1.1  christos 				     + ent->plt.offset);
   9546  1.1  christos 
   9547  1.1  christos 		    if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
   9548  1.8  christos 			|| !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9549  1.1  christos 			|| h->dynindx == -1)
   9550  1.8  christos 		      {
   9551  1.8  christos 			/* We don't need to fill in the .plt.  The ppc dynamic
   9552  1.8  christos 			   linker will fill it in.  */
   9553  1.8  christos 		      }
   9554  1.8  christos 		    else
   9555  1.8  christos 		      {
   9556  1.8  christos 			bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
   9557  1.8  christos 				       + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   9558  1.8  christos 				       + htab->glink->output_offset);
   9559  1.8  christos 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
   9560  1.8  christos 				    plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
   9561  1.8  christos 		      }
   9562  1.8  christos 		  }
   9563  1.1  christos 	      }
   9564  1.8  christos 
   9565  1.8  christos 	    if (relplt != NULL)
   9566  1.8  christos 	      {
   9567  1.8  christos 		/* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section.  */
   9568  1.8  christos 		if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9569  1.1  christos 		    || h->dynindx == -1)
   9570  1.8  christos 		  {
   9571  1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9572  1.1  christos 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9573  1.1  christos 		    else
   9574  1.1  christos 		      rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9575  1.1  christos 		    loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
   9576  1.1  christos 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9577  1.1  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9578  1.1  christos 		  }
   9579  1.1  christos 		else
   9580  1.8  christos 		  {
   9581  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
   9582  1.1  christos 		    loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
   9583  1.1  christos 					      * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9584  1.1  christos 		    if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
   9585  1.8  christos 		      htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9586  1.8  christos 		  }
   9587  1.8  christos 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9588  1.8  christos 	      }
   9589  1.1  christos 	    doneone = TRUE;
   9590  1.1  christos 	  }
   9591  1.8  christos 
   9592  1.8  christos 	if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
   9593  1.1  christos 	    || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9594  1.6  christos 	    || h->dynindx == -1)
   9595  1.1  christos 	  {
   9596  1.1  christos 	    unsigned char *p;
   9597  1.1  christos 	    asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
   9598  1.1  christos 
   9599  1.1  christos 	    if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
   9600  1.1  christos 		|| h->dynindx == -1)
   9601  1.8  christos 	      {
   9602  1.8  christos 		if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9603  1.8  christos 		  plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9604  1.8  christos 		else
   9605  1.8  christos 		  break;
   9606  1.8  christos 	      }
   9607  1.8  christos 
   9608  1.8  christos 	    p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9609  1.8  christos 	    write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
   9610  1.8  christos 
   9611  1.8  christos 	    if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9612  1.8  christos 	      /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub.  */
   9613  1.8  christos 	      break;
   9614  1.8  christos 	  }
   9615  1.8  christos 	else
   9616  1.8  christos 	  break;
   9617  1.8  christos       }
   9618  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   9619  1.8  christos }
   9620  1.8  christos 
   9621  1.8  christos /* Finish up PLT handling.  */
   9622  1.8  christos 
   9623  1.8  christos bfd_boolean
   9624  1.8  christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9625  1.8  christos {
   9626  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9627  1.8  christos   bfd *ibfd;
   9628  1.8  christos 
   9629  1.8  christos   if (!htab)
   9630  1.8  christos     return TRUE;
   9631  1.8  christos 
   9632  1.8  christos   elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
   9633  1.8  christos 
   9634  1.8  christos   for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
   9635  1.8  christos     {
   9636  1.8  christos       bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
   9637  1.8  christos       struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
   9638  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
   9639  1.8  christos       bfd_size_type locsymcount;
   9640  1.8  christos       Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
   9641  1.8  christos       struct plt_entry *ent;
   9642  1.8  christos 
   9643  1.8  christos       if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
   9644  1.8  christos 	continue;
   9645  1.8  christos 
   9646  1.8  christos       local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
   9647  1.8  christos       if (!local_got)
   9648  1.8  christos 	continue;
   9649  1.9  christos 
   9650  1.8  christos       symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
   9651  1.8  christos       locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
   9652  1.8  christos       end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
   9653  1.8  christos       local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
   9654  1.9  christos       end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
   9655  1.8  christos       for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
   9656  1.8  christos 	for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9657  1.8  christos 	  {
   9658  1.8  christos 	    if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9659  1.8  christos 	      {
   9660  1.8  christos 		Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
   9661  1.8  christos 		asection *sym_sec;
   9662  1.8  christos 		asection *plt, *relplt;
   9663  1.8  christos 		bfd_byte *loc;
   9664  1.8  christos 		bfd_vma val;
   9665  1.8  christos 		Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9666  1.8  christos 		unsigned char *p;
   9667  1.8  christos 
   9668  1.8  christos 		if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
   9669  1.8  christos 				lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
   9670  1.8  christos 		  {
   9671  1.8  christos 		    if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9672  1.8  christos 		      free (local_syms);
   9673  1.8  christos 		    return FALSE;
   9674  1.8  christos 		  }
   9675  1.8  christos 
   9676  1.8  christos 		val = sym->st_value;
   9677  1.8  christos 		if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
   9678  1.8  christos 		  val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
   9679  1.8  christos 
   9680  1.8  christos 		if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
   9681  1.8  christos 		  {
   9682  1.8  christos 		    htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
   9683  1.8  christos 		    plt = htab->elf.iplt;
   9684  1.8  christos 		    relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
   9685  1.8  christos 		    rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
   9686  1.8  christos 		  }
   9687  1.8  christos 		else
   9688  1.8  christos 		  {
   9689  1.8  christos 		    plt = htab->pltlocal;
   9690  1.8  christos 		    if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   9691  1.8  christos 		      {
   9692  1.8  christos 			relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
   9693  1.8  christos 			rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
   9694  1.9  christos 		      }
   9695  1.8  christos 		    else
   9696  1.8  christos 		      {
   9697  1.8  christos 			loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
   9698  1.8  christos 			bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
   9699  1.8  christos 			continue;
   9700  1.8  christos 		      }
   9701  1.8  christos 		  }
   9702  1.8  christos 
   9703  1.8  christos 		rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
   9704  1.8  christos 				 + plt->output_offset
   9705  1.8  christos 				 + plt->output_section->vma);
   9706  1.8  christos 		rela.r_addend = val;
   9707  1.8  christos 		loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
   9708  1.8  christos 					  * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
   9709  1.8  christos 		bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9710  1.8  christos 
   9711  1.8  christos 		p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
   9712  1.8  christos 		write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
   9713  1.8  christos 	      }
   9714  1.8  christos 	  }
   9715  1.8  christos 
   9716  1.8  christos       if (local_syms != NULL
   9717  1.8  christos 	  && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
   9718  1.8  christos 	{
   9719  1.8  christos 	  if (!info->keep_memory)
   9720  1.8  christos 	    free (local_syms);
   9721  1.8  christos 	  else
   9722  1.8  christos 	    symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
   9723  1.8  christos 	}
   9724  1.8  christos     }
   9725  1.8  christos   return TRUE;
   9726  1.8  christos }
   9727  1.8  christos 
   9728  1.8  christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling.  We set the contents of various
   9729  1.8  christos    dynamic sections here.  */
   9730  1.8  christos 
   9731  1.8  christos static bfd_boolean
   9732  1.8  christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
   9733  1.8  christos 			       struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9734  1.8  christos 			       struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
   9735  1.8  christos 			       Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
   9736  1.8  christos {
   9737  1.8  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9738  1.8  christos   struct plt_entry *ent;
   9739  1.8  christos 
   9740  1.8  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9741  1.8  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
   9742  1.8  christos 	   h->root.root.string);
   9743  1.8  christos #endif
   9744  1.8  christos 
   9745  1.8  christos   if (!h->def_regular
   9746  1.8  christos       || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
   9747  1.8  christos     for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
   9748  1.8  christos       if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
   9749  1.8  christos 	{
   9750  1.8  christos 	  if (!h->def_regular)
   9751  1.8  christos 	    {
   9752  1.8  christos 	      /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
   9753  1.8  christos 		 defined in the .plt section.  Leave the value if
   9754  1.8  christos 		 there were any relocations where pointer equality
   9755  1.8  christos 		 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
   9756  1.8  christos 		 make function pointer comparisons work between an
   9757  1.8  christos 		 application and shared library), otherwise set it
   9758  1.8  christos 		 to zero.  */
   9759  1.8  christos 	      sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
   9760  1.8  christos 	      if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
   9761  1.8  christos 		sym->st_value = 0;
   9762  1.8  christos 	      else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
   9763  1.8  christos 		{
   9764  1.8  christos 		  /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
   9765  1.8  christos 		     that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
   9766  1.8  christos 		     function pointer.  */
   9767  1.8  christos 		  sym->st_value = 0;
   9768  1.8  christos 		}
   9769  1.8  christos 	    }
   9770  1.8  christos 	  else
   9771  1.1  christos 	    {
   9772  1.1  christos 	      /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
   9773  1.1  christos 		 executable to the glink entry.  This is to avoid
   9774  1.1  christos 		 text relocations.  We can't do this for ifunc in
   9775  1.1  christos 		 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
   9776  1.1  christos 		 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
   9777  1.1  christos 		 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
   9778  1.1  christos 		 relocation.  */
   9779  1.1  christos 	      sym->st_shndx
   9780  1.1  christos 		= (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
   9781  1.1  christos 		   (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
   9782  1.1  christos 	      sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
   9783  1.1  christos 			       + htab->glink->output_offset
   9784  1.1  christos 			       + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
   9785  1.1  christos 	    }
   9786  1.1  christos 	  break;
   9787  1.1  christos 	}
   9788  1.7  christos 
   9789  1.7  christos   if (h->needs_copy)
   9790  1.1  christos     {
   9791  1.7  christos       asection *s;
   9792  1.1  christos       Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   9793  1.1  christos       bfd_byte *loc;
   9794  1.1  christos 
   9795  1.1  christos       /* This symbols needs a copy reloc.  Set it up.  */
   9796  1.1  christos 
   9797  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9798  1.1  christos       fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
   9799  1.1  christos #endif
   9800  1.1  christos 
   9801  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
   9802  1.1  christos 
   9803  1.1  christos       if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
   9804  1.1  christos 	s = htab->relsbss;
   9805  1.1  christos       else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
   9806  1.1  christos 	s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
   9807  1.1  christos       else
   9808  1.1  christos 	s = htab->elf.srelbss;
   9809  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
   9810  1.1  christos 
   9811  1.1  christos       rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
   9812  1.1  christos       rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
   9813  1.1  christos       rela.r_addend = 0;
   9814  1.1  christos       loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   9815  1.7  christos       bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   9816  1.1  christos     }
   9817  1.1  christos 
   9818  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9819  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "\n");
   9820  1.1  christos #endif
   9821  1.1  christos 
   9822  1.1  christos   return TRUE;
   9823  1.1  christos }
   9824  1.1  christos 
   9825  1.1  christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
   9827  1.1  christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
   9828  1.1  christos 			  const asection *rel_sec,
   9829  1.1  christos 			  const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
   9830  1.1  christos {
   9831  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9832  1.1  christos 
   9833  1.1  christos   if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
   9834  1.1  christos     return reloc_class_ifunc;
   9835  1.1  christos 
   9836  1.1  christos   switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
   9837  1.1  christos     {
   9838  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
   9839  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_relative;
   9840  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
   9841  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_plt;
   9842  1.1  christos     case R_PPC_COPY:
   9843  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_copy;
   9844  1.1  christos     default:
   9845  1.1  christos       return reloc_class_normal;
   9846  1.1  christos     }
   9847  1.1  christos }
   9848  1.7  christos 
   9849  1.1  christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections.  */
   9851  1.1  christos 
   9852  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   9853  1.1  christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
   9854  1.1  christos 				 struct bfd_link_info *info)
   9855  1.1  christos {
   9856  1.1  christos   asection *sdyn;
   9857  1.1  christos   struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
   9858  1.1  christos   bfd_vma got;
   9859  1.7  christos   bfd *dynobj;
   9860  1.1  christos   bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
   9861  1.1  christos 
   9862  1.1  christos #ifdef DEBUG
   9863  1.1  christos   fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
   9864  1.1  christos #endif
   9865  1.1  christos 
   9866  1.1  christos   htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
   9867  1.1  christos   dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
   9868  1.1  christos   sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
   9869  1.1  christos 
   9870  1.1  christos   got = 0;
   9871  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
   9872  1.1  christos     got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9873  1.9  christos 
   9874  1.7  christos   if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   9875  1.1  christos     {
   9876  1.7  christos       Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
   9877  1.1  christos 
   9878  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
   9879  1.1  christos 
   9880  1.1  christos       dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
   9881  1.7  christos       dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
   9882  1.1  christos       for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
   9883  1.1  christos 	{
   9884  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
   9885  1.7  christos 	  asection *s;
   9886  1.1  christos 
   9887  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
   9888  1.1  christos 
   9889  1.1  christos 	  switch (dyn.d_tag)
   9890  1.1  christos 	    {
   9891  1.1  christos 	    case DT_PLTGOT:
   9892  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
   9893  1.7  christos 		s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
   9894  1.7  christos 	      else
   9895  1.7  christos 		s = htab->elf.splt;
   9896  1.7  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   9897  1.7  christos 	      break;
   9898  1.7  christos 
   9899  1.7  christos 	    case DT_PLTRELSZ:
   9900  1.7  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
   9901  1.7  christos 	      break;
   9902  1.1  christos 
   9903  1.1  christos 	    case DT_JMPREL:
   9904  1.1  christos 	      s = htab->elf.srelplt;
   9905  1.9  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
   9906  1.1  christos 	      break;
   9907  1.1  christos 
   9908  1.1  christos 	    case DT_PPC_GOT:
   9909  1.1  christos 	      dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
   9910  1.1  christos 	      break;
   9911  1.1  christos 
   9912  1.1  christos 	    case DT_TEXTREL:
   9913  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
   9914  1.1  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   9915  1.7  christos 		  (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   9916  1.7  christos 		     "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   9917  1.1  christos 	      else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
   9918  1.7  christos 		info->callbacks->einfo
   9919  1.7  christos 		  (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
   9920  1.1  christos 		     "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
   9921  1.1  christos 	      continue;
   9922  1.1  christos 
   9923  1.1  christos 	    default:
   9924  1.1  christos 	      if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   9925  1.1  christos 		  && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
   9926  1.1  christos 		break;
   9927  1.1  christos 	      continue;
   9928  1.1  christos 	    }
   9929  1.1  christos 
   9930  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
   9931  1.1  christos 	}
   9932  1.1  christos     }
   9933  1.1  christos 
   9934  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
   9935  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   9936  1.1  christos     {
   9937  1.1  christos       if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
   9938  1.1  christos 	  || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
   9939  1.1  christos 	{
   9940  1.1  christos 	  unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
   9941  1.1  christos 
   9942  1.1  christos 	  p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
   9943  1.1  christos 	  if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
   9944  1.7  christos 	    {
   9945  1.8  christos 	      /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
   9946  1.8  christos 		 so that a function can easily find the address of
   9947  1.8  christos 		 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.  */
   9948  1.8  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
   9949  1.1  christos 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   9950  1.1  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
   9951  1.1  christos 	    }
   9952  1.1  christos 
   9953  1.7  christos 	  if (sdyn != NULL)
   9954  1.1  christos 	    {
   9955  1.1  christos 	      bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
   9956  1.1  christos 	      BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
   9957  1.9  christos 			  < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
   9958  1.7  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
   9959  1.7  christos 	    }
   9960  1.7  christos 	}
   9961  1.1  christos       else
   9962  1.7  christos 	{
   9963  1.1  christos 	  /* xgettext:c-format */
   9964  1.6  christos 	  _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
   9965  1.1  christos 			      htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
   9966  1.1  christos 			      (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
   9967  1.1  christos 			       ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
   9968  1.6  christos 	  bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
   9969  1.1  christos 	  ret = FALSE;
   9970  1.1  christos 	}
   9971  1.1  christos 
   9972  1.1  christos       elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
   9973  1.1  christos     }
   9974  1.1  christos 
   9975  1.1  christos   /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table.  */
   9976  1.1  christos   if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
   9977  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt != NULL
   9978  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
   9979  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
   9980  1.1  christos     {
   9981  1.1  christos       asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
   9982  1.1  christos       /* Use the right PLT. */
   9983  1.1  christos       const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
   9984  1.1  christos 				  ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
   9985  1.1  christos 				  : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
   9986  1.1  christos 
   9987  1.1  christos       if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
   9988  1.1  christos 	{
   9989  1.6  christos 	  bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
   9990  1.1  christos 
   9991  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
   9992  1.1  christos 		      splt->contents +  0);
   9993  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
   9994  1.1  christos 		      splt->contents +  4);
   9995  1.1  christos 	}
   9996  1.1  christos       else
   9997  1.7  christos 	{
   9998  1.7  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents +  0);
   9999  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents +  4);
   10000  1.1  christos 	}
   10001  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents +  8);
   10002  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
   10003  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
   10004  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
   10005  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
   10006  1.7  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
   10007  1.7  christos 
   10008  1.1  christos       if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
   10009  1.1  christos 	{
   10010  1.1  christos 	  Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
   10011  1.1  christos 	  bfd_byte *loc;
   10012  1.1  christos 
   10013  1.1  christos 	  loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
   10014  1.1  christos 
   10015  1.1  christos 	  /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction.  */
   10016  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10017  1.1  christos 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10018  1.1  christos 			   + 2);
   10019  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10020  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10021  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   10022  1.1  christos 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10023  1.1  christos 
   10024  1.1  christos 	  /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction.  */
   10025  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
   10026  1.1  christos 			   + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
   10027  1.1  christos 			   + 6);
   10028  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10029  1.1  christos 	  rela.r_addend = 0;
   10030  1.1  christos 	  bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
   10031  1.1  christos 	  loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10032  1.1  christos 
   10033  1.1  christos 	  /* Fix up the remaining relocations.  They may have the wrong
   10034  1.1  christos 	     symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
   10035  1.1  christos 	     in which symbols were output.  */
   10036  1.1  christos 	  while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
   10037  1.1  christos 	    {
   10038  1.1  christos 	      Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
   10039  1.1  christos 
   10040  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10041  1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
   10042  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10043  1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10044  1.1  christos 
   10045  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10046  1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
   10047  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10048  1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10049  1.1  christos 
   10050  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
   10051  1.1  christos 	      rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
   10052  1.1  christos 	      bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
   10053  1.1  christos 	      loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
   10054  1.1  christos 	    }
   10055  1.1  christos 	}
   10056  1.1  christos     }
   10057  1.1  christos 
   10058  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink != NULL
   10059  1.1  christos       && htab->glink->contents != NULL
   10060  1.1  christos       && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
   10061  1.1  christos     {
   10062  1.1  christos       unsigned char *p;
   10063  1.1  christos       unsigned char *endp;
   10064  1.1  christos       bfd_vma res0;
   10065  1.1  christos 
   10066  1.1  christos       /*
   10067  1.1  christos        * PIC glink code is the following:
   10068  1.1  christos        *
   10069  1.1  christos        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10070  1.1  christos        *   addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
   10071  1.1  christos        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
   10072  1.1  christos        *   mtctr 11
   10073  1.1  christos        *   bctr
   10074  1.8  christos        *
   10075  1.1  christos        * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
   10076  1.8  christos        * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
   10077  1.8  christos        * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
   10078  1.1  christos        * res_0:	b PLTresolve
   10079  1.1  christos        * res_1:	b PLTresolve
   10080  1.8  christos        * .
   10081  1.1  christos        * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
   10082  1.8  christos        * res_n_m3: nop
   10083  1.1  christos        * res_n_m2: nop
   10084  1.1  christos        * res_n_m1:
   10085  1.1  christos        *
   10086  1.1  christos        * PLTresolve:
   10087  1.1  christos        *    addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
   10088  1.1  christos        *    mflr 0
   10089  1.1  christos        *    bcl 20,31,1f
   10090  1.1  christos        * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
   10091  1.1  christos        *    mflr 12
   10092  1.1  christos        *    mtlr 0
   10093  1.1  christos        *    sub 11,11,12		# r11 = index * 4
   10094  1.1  christos        *    addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
   10095  1.1  christos        *    lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12)	# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10096  1.8  christos        *    lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10097  1.8  christos        *    mtctr 0
   10098  1.1  christos        *    add 0,11,11
   10099  1.1  christos        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10100  1.8  christos        *    bctr
   10101  1.8  christos        *
   10102  1.1  christos        * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
   10103  1.1  christos        *
   10104  1.1  christos        * # ith PLT code stub.
   10105  1.1  christos        *   lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
   10106  1.1  christos        *   lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
   10107  1.1  christos        *   mtctr 11
   10108  1.1  christos        *   bctr
   10109  1.1  christos        *
   10110  1.1  christos        * The branch table is the same, then comes
   10111  1.3  christos        *
   10112  1.1  christos        * PLTresolve:
   10113  1.1  christos        *    lis 12,(got+4)@ha
   10114  1.1  christos        *    addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
   10115  1.1  christos        *    lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12)		# got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
   10116  1.1  christos        *    addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l	# r11 = index * 4
   10117  1.1  christos        *    mtctr 0
   10118  1.1  christos        *    add 0,11,11
   10119  1.1  christos        *    lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12)	# got[2] contains the map address
   10120  1.1  christos        *    add 11,0,11			# r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
   10121  1.1  christos        *    bctr
   10122  1.1  christos        */
   10123  1.1  christos 
   10124  1.1  christos       /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
   10125  1.1  christos 	 and perhaps some padding.  */
   10126  1.3  christos       p = htab->glink->contents;
   10127  1.3  christos       p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
   10128  1.3  christos       endp = htab->glink->contents;
   10129  1.3  christos       endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10130  1.3  christos       while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
   10131  1.3  christos 	{
   10132  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
   10133  1.3  christos 	  p += 4;
   10134  1.3  christos 	}
   10135  1.3  christos       while (p < endp)
   10136  1.3  christos 	{
   10137  1.3  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
   10138  1.3  christos 	  p += 4;
   10139  1.3  christos 	}
   10140  1.3  christos 
   10141  1.3  christos       res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
   10142  1.3  christos 	      + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10143  1.3  christos 	      + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10144  1.3  christos 
   10145  1.3  christos       if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
   10146  1.3  christos 	{
   10147  1.3  christos 	  /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
   10148  1.3  christos 	     result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
   10149  1.3  christos 	     glink branch table.  */
   10150  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
   10151  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma page_addr;
   10152  1.3  christos 	  bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10153  1.3  christos 				 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10154  1.3  christos 
   10155  1.3  christos 	  for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
   10156  1.3  christos 	       page_addr > glink_start;
   10157  1.3  christos 	       page_addr -= pagesize)
   10158  1.3  christos 	    {
   10159  1.1  christos 	      /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing.  */
   10160  1.8  christos 	      bfd_byte *loc;
   10161  1.6  christos 	      unsigned int insn;
   10162  1.1  christos 
   10163  1.1  christos 	      loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
   10164  1.1  christos 	      insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
   10165  1.1  christos 	      if (insn == BCTR)
   10166  1.1  christos 		{
   10167  1.1  christos 		  /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
   10168  1.1  christos 		     one other call stub before this one.  */
   10169  1.8  christos 		  insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
   10170  1.8  christos 		  if (insn == BCTR)
   10171  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10172  1.8  christos 		  else
   10173  1.8  christos 		    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
   10174  1.8  christos 		}
   10175  1.8  christos 	    }
   10176  1.8  christos 	}
   10177  1.8  christos 
   10178  1.8  christos       /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub.  */
   10179  1.8  christos       endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
   10180  1.8  christos       if (bfd_link_pic (info))
   10181  1.8  christos 	{
   10182  1.8  christos 	  bfd_vma bcl;
   10183  1.8  christos 
   10184  1.8  christos 	  bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
   10185  1.1  christos 		 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10186  1.1  christos 		 + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10187  1.8  christos 
   10188  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
   10189  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10190  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
   10191  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10192  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
   10193  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10194  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
   10195  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10196  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
   10197  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10198  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
   10199  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10200  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
   10201  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10202  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10203  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10204  1.1  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
   10205  1.8  christos 	    {
   10206  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10207  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10208  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
   10209  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10210  1.8  christos 	    }
   10211  1.8  christos 	  else
   10212  1.8  christos 	    {
   10213  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
   10214  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10215  1.8  christos 	      bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10216  1.8  christos 	      p += 4;
   10217  1.8  christos 	    }
   10218  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10219  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10220  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10221  1.8  christos 	}
   10222  1.1  christos       else
   10223  1.8  christos 	{
   10224  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
   10225  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10226  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
   10227  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10228  1.8  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10229  1.8  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10230  1.8  christos 	  else
   10231  1.8  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
   10232  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10233  1.8  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
   10234  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10235  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
   10236  1.8  christos 	  p += 4;
   10237  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
   10238  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10239  1.1  christos 	  if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
   10240  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
   10241  1.1  christos 	  else
   10242  1.1  christos 	    bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
   10243  1.1  christos 	}
   10244  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10245  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
   10246  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10247  1.1  christos       bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
   10248  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10249  1.1  christos       while (p < endp)
   10250  1.1  christos 	{
   10251  1.1  christos 	  bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
   10252  1.1  christos 		      htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
   10253  1.1  christos 	  p += 4;
   10254  1.1  christos 	}
   10255  1.1  christos       BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
   10256  1.1  christos     }
   10257  1.1  christos 
   10258  1.1  christos   if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
   10259  1.1  christos       && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
   10260  1.1  christos     {
   10261  1.1  christos       unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10262  1.1  christos       bfd_vma val;
   10263  1.1  christos 
   10264  1.1  christos       p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
   10265  1.1  christos       /* FDE length.  */
   10266  1.1  christos       p += 4;
   10267  1.1  christos       /* CIE pointer.  */
   10268  1.3  christos       p += 4;
   10269  1.1  christos       /* Offset to .glink.  */
   10270  1.3  christos       val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
   10271  1.1  christos 	     + htab->glink->output_offset);
   10272  1.1  christos       val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
   10273  1.1  christos 	      + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
   10274  1.1  christos       val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
   10275  1.8  christos       bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
   10276  1.3  christos 
   10277  1.8  christos       if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
   10278  1.1  christos 	  && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
   10279  1.1  christos 					       htab->glink_eh_frame,
   10280  1.1  christos 					       htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
   10281  1.1  christos 	return FALSE;
   10282  1.1  christos     }
   10283  1.1  christos 
   10284  1.1  christos   return ret;
   10285  1.1  christos }
   10286  1.1  christos 
   10287  1.1  christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM	powerpc_elf32_le_vec
   10289  1.7  christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME	"elf32-powerpcle"
   10290  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vec
   10291  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc"
   10292  1.1  christos #define ELF_ARCH		bfd_arch_powerpc
   10293  1.3  christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID		PPC32_ELF_DATA
   10294  1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE	EM_PPC
   10295  1.1  christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE		0x10000
   10296  1.1  christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE	0x1000
   10297  1.1  christos #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE	ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
   10298  1.1  christos #define elf_info_to_howto	ppc_elf_info_to_howto
   10299  1.1  christos 
   10300  1.1  christos #ifdef  EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10301  1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1	EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
   10302  1.1  christos #endif
   10303  1.1  christos 
   10304  1.1  christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
   10305  1.1  christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2	EM_PPC_OLD
   10306  1.1  christos #endif
   10307  1.1  christos 
   10308  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded	1
   10309  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro	1
   10310  1.8  christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections	1
   10311  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount	1
   10312  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal		1
   10313  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize	1
   10314  1.1  christos 
   10315  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject			ppc_elf_mkobject
   10316  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data	ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
   10317  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section		ppc_elf_relax_section
   10318  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
   10319  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup		ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
   10320  1.8  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags		ppc_elf_set_private_flags
   10321  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create	ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
   10322  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab		ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
   10323  1.1  christos 
   10324  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_object_p			ppc_elf_object_p
   10325  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook		ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
   10326  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr		ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
   10327  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section		ppc_elf_relocate_section
   10328  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
   10329  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs		ppc_elf_check_relocs
   10330  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible		_bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
   10331  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol	ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
   10332  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
   10333  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook		ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
   10334  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
   10335  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol			ppc_elf_hash_symbol
   10336  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
   10337  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections	ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
   10338  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections		ppc_elf_fake_sections
   10339  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers	ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
   10340  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map		ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
   10341  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus		ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
   10342  1.3  christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo			ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
   10343  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note		ppc_elf_write_core_note
   10344  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class		ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
   10345  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing	ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
   10346  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing	ppc_elf_final_write_processing
   10347  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_write_section		ppc_elf_write_section
   10348  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr		ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
   10349  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val			ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
   10350  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded		ppc_elf_action_discarded
   10351  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section		_bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
   10352  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook	ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
   10353  1.1  christos 
   10354  1.1  christos #include "elf32-target.h"
   10355  1.1  christos 
   10356  1.1  christos /* FreeBSD Target */
   10357  1.1  christos 
   10358  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10359  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10360  1.3  christos 
   10361  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10362  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM  powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
   10363  1.1  christos #undef  TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10364  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
   10365  1.1  christos 
   10366  1.9  christos #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10367  1.9  christos #define ELF_OSABI	ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
   10368  1.9  christos 
   10369  1.1  christos #undef  elf32_bed
   10370  1.1  christos #define elf32_bed	elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
   10371  1.7  christos 
   10372  1.1  christos #include "elf32-target.h"
   10373  1.1  christos 
   10374  1.1  christos /* VxWorks Target */
   10375  1.1  christos 
   10376  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
   10377  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
   10378  1.1  christos 
   10379  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
   10380  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM		powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
   10381  1.1  christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
   10382  1.1  christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME		"elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
   10383  1.1  christos 
   10384  1.1  christos #undef  ELF_OSABI
   10385  1.1  christos 
   10386  1.1  christos #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
   10387  1.1  christos #define ELF_TARGET_OS		is_vxworks
   10388  1.1  christos 
   10389  1.1  christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt.  */
   10390  1.1  christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
   10391  1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
   10392  1.1  christos {
   10393  1.8  christos   if (sec->name == NULL)
   10394  1.1  christos     return NULL;
   10395  1.1  christos 
   10396  1.1  christos   if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
   10397  1.1  christos     return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10398  1.1  christos 
   10399  1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
   10400  1.1  christos }
   10401  1.1  christos 
   10402  1.1  christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
   10403  1.1  christos    appropriately for VxWorks.  */
   10404  1.1  christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
   10405  1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
   10406  1.1  christos {
   10407  1.7  christos   struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
   10408  1.7  christos 
   10409  1.1  christos   ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
   10410  1.1  christos   if (ret)
   10411  1.1  christos     {
   10412  1.7  christos       struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
   10413  1.7  christos 	= (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
   10414  1.1  christos       htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
   10415  1.1  christos       htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10416  1.7  christos       htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10417  1.1  christos       htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
   10418  1.1  christos     }
   10419  1.9  christos   return ret;
   10420  1.9  christos }
   10421  1.1  christos 
   10422  1.9  christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded.  */
   10423  1.9  christos static bfd_boolean
   10424  1.1  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
   10425  1.1  christos 				 struct bfd_link_info *info,
   10426  1.1  christos 				 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
   10427  1.1  christos 				 const char **namep,
   10428  1.1  christos 				 flagword *flagsp,
   10429  1.1  christos 				 asection **secp,
   10430  1.1  christos 				 bfd_vma *valp)
   10431  1.1  christos {
   10432  1.1  christos   if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
   10433  1.1  christos 				    valp))
   10434  1.1  christos     return FALSE;
   10435  1.1  christos 
   10436  1.1  christos   return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
   10437  1.1  christos }
   10438  1.1  christos 
   10439  1.1  christos static bfd_boolean
   10440  1.7  christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
   10441  1.7  christos {
   10442  1.1  christos   ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
   10443  1.1  christos   return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
   10444  1.1  christos }
   10445  1.1  christos 
   10446  1.1  christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
   10447  1.1  christos    define it.  */
   10448  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
   10449  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym		1
   10450  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
   10451  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt		1
   10452  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
   10453  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset		0
   10454  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
   10455  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded		0
   10456  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
   10457  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly		1
   10458  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
   10459  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size		12
   10460  1.1  christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
   10461  1.1  christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt		1
   10462  1.1  christos 
   10463  1.1  christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
   10464  1.1  christos 
   10465  1.1  christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
   10466  1.1  christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
   10467  1.1  christos   ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
   10468                #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
   10469                #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
   10470                  ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
   10471                #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
   10472                #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
   10473                  elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
   10474                #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
   10475                #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
   10476                  ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
   10477                #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
   10478                #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
   10479                  ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
   10480                #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
   10481                #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
   10482                  elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
   10483                
   10484                #undef elf32_bed
   10485                #define elf32_bed				ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
   10486                
   10487                #include "elf32-target.h"
   10488